libpq.sgml 265.3 KB
Newer Older
1
<!-- doc/src/sgml/libpq.sgml -->
2

3 4
<chapter id="libpq">
 <title><application>libpq</application> - C Library</title>
5

6 7 8
 <indexterm zone="libpq">
  <primary>libpq</primary>
 </indexterm>
9

10 11 12
 <indexterm zone="libpq">
  <primary>C</primary>
 </indexterm>
13

14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
 <para>
  <application>libpq</application> is the <acronym>C</acronym>
  application programmer's interface to <productname>PostgreSQL</>.
  <application>libpq</> is a set of library functions that allow
  client programs to pass queries to the <productname>PostgreSQL</>
  backend server and to receive the results of these queries.
 </para>

 <para>
  <application>libpq</> is also the underlying engine for several
  other <productname>PostgreSQL</> application interfaces, including
  those written for C++, Perl, Python, Tcl and <application>ECPG</>.
  So some aspects of <application>libpq</>'s behavior will be
  important to you if you use one of those packages.  In particular,
  <xref linkend="libpq-envars">,
  <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass"> and
  <xref linkend="libpq-ssl">
  describe behavior that is visible to the user of any application
  that uses <application>libpq</>.
 </para>

 <para>
  Some short programs are included at the end of this chapter (<xref linkend="libpq-example">) to show how
  to write programs that use <application>libpq</application>.  There are also several
  complete examples of <application>libpq</application> applications in the
  directory <filename>src/test/examples</filename> in the source code distribution.
 </para>

 <para>
  Client programs that use <application>libpq</application> must
  include the header file
  <filename>libpq-fe.h</filename><indexterm><primary>libpq-fe.h</></>
  and must link with the <application>libpq</application> library.
 </para>
48

49
 <sect1 id="libpq-connect">
50
  <title>Database Connection Control Functions</title>
51

52
  <para>
53 54
   The following functions deal with making a connection to a
   <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> backend server.  An
55 56 57
   application program can have several backend connections open at
   one time.  (One reason to do that is to access more than one
   database.)  Each connection is represented by a
T
Tom Lane 已提交
58
   <structname>PGconn</><indexterm><primary>PGconn</></> object, which
59 60
   is obtained from the function <function>PQconnectdb</>,
   <function>PQconnectdbParams</>, or
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
61 62 63 64 65 66
   <function>PQsetdbLogin</>.  Note that these functions will always
   return a non-null object pointer, unless perhaps there is too
   little memory even to allocate the <structname>PGconn</> object.
   The <function>PQstatus</> function should be called to check
   whether a connection was successfully made before queries are sent
   via the connection object.
67

68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77
   <warning>
    <para>
     On Unix, forking a process with open libpq connections can lead to
     unpredictable results because the parent and child processes share
     the same sockets and operating system resources.  For this reason,
     such usage is not recommended, though doing an <function>exec</> from
     the child process to load a new executable is safe.
    </para>
   </warning>

78 79 80
   <note>
    <para>
     On Windows, there is a way to improve performance if a single
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
81
     database connection is repeatedly started and shutdown.  Internally,
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
82 83 84 85
     libpq calls <function>WSAStartup()</> and <function>WSACleanup()</> for connection startup
     and shutdown, respectively.  <function>WSAStartup()</> increments an internal
     Windows library reference count which is decremented by <function>WSACleanup()</>.
     When the reference count is just one, calling <function>WSACleanup()</> frees
86 87
     all resources and all DLLs are unloaded.  This is an expensive
     operation.  To avoid this, an application can manually call
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
88
     <function>WSAStartup()</> so resources will not be freed when the last database
89 90 91
     connection is closed.
    </para>
   </note>
92

93
   <variablelist>
94
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconnectdbparams">
95
     <term><function>PQconnectdbParams</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectdbParams</></></term>
96 97 98
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Makes a new connection to the database server.
99

100 101 102
<synopsis>
PGconn *PQconnectdbParams(const char **keywords, const char **values, int expand_dbname);
</synopsis>
103 104
      </para>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
105 106
      <para>
       This function opens a new database connection using the parameters taken
107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114
       from two <symbol>NULL</symbol>-terminated arrays. The first,
       <literal>keywords</literal>, is defined as an array of strings, each one
       being a key word. The second, <literal>values</literal>, gives the value
       for each key word. Unlike <function>PQsetdbLogin</> below, the parameter
       set can be extended without changing the function signature, so use of
       this function (or its nonblocking analogs <function>PQconnectStartParams</>
       and <function>PQconnectPoll</function>) is preferred for new application
       programming.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
115 116
      </para>

117 118 119 120 121 122
      <para>
       When <literal>expand_dbname</literal> is non-zero, the
       <parameter>dbname</parameter> key word value is allowed to be recognized
       as a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string. See below for details.
      </para>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
123
      <para>
124 125 126 127
       The passed arrays can be empty to use all default parameters, or can
       contain one or more parameter settings. They should be matched in length.
       Processing will stop with the last non-<symbol>NULL</symbol> element
       of the <literal>keywords</literal> array.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
128 129 130 131 132 133
      </para>

      <para>
       The currently recognized parameter key words are:

       <variablelist>
134
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-host" xreflabel="host">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151
         <term><literal>host</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Name of host to connect to.<indexterm><primary>host name</></>
           If this begins with a slash, it specifies Unix-domain
           communication rather than TCP/IP communication; the value is the
           name of the directory in which the socket file is stored.  The
           default behavior when <literal>host</literal> is not specified
           is to connect to a Unix-domain
           socket<indexterm><primary>Unix domain socket</></> in
           <filename>/tmp</filename> (or whatever socket directory was specified
           when <productname>PostgreSQL</> was built). On machines without
           Unix-domain sockets, the default is to connect to <literal>localhost</>.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

152
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-hostaddr" xreflabel="hostaddr">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161
         <term><literal>hostaddr</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Numeric IP address of host to connect to.  This should be in the
           standard IPv4 address format, e.g., <literal>172.28.40.9</>.  If
           your machine supports IPv6, you can also use those addresses.
           TCP/IP communication is
           always used when a nonempty string is specified for this parameter.
          </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
162

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
163 164
          <para>
           Using <literal>hostaddr</> instead of <literal>host</> allows the
165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172
           application to avoid a host name look-up, which might be important
           in applications with time constraints. However, a host name is
           required for Kerberos, GSSAPI, or SSPI authentication, as well as
           for full SSL certificate verification. The following rules are
           used:
           If <literal>host</> is specified without <literal>hostaddr</>,
           a host name lookup occurs.
           If <literal>hostaddr</> is specified without <literal>host</>,
173
           the value for <literal>hostaddr</> gives the server network address.
174 175 176
           The connection attempt will fail in any of the cases where a
           host name is required.
           If both <literal>host</> and <literal>hostaddr</> are specified,
177
           the value for <literal>hostaddr</> gives the server network address.
178 179 180 181 182 183 184
           The value for <literal>host</> is ignored unless needed for
           authentication or verification purposes, in which case it will be
           used as the host name.  Note that authentication is likely to fail
           if <literal>host</> is not the name of the machine at
           <literal>hostaddr</>.
           Also, note that <literal>host</> rather than <literal>hostaddr</>
           is used to identify the connection in <filename>~/.pgpass</> (see
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
185 186
           <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">).
          </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
187

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
188 189 190 191 192 193 194 195
          <para>
           Without either a host name or host address,
           <application>libpq</application> will connect using a
           local Unix-domain socket; or on machines without Unix-domain
           sockets, it will attempt to connect to <literal>localhost</>.
          </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
196

197
         <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-port" xreflabel="port">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
198 199 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207
          <term><literal>port</literal></term>
          <listitem>
          <para>
           Port number to connect to at the server host, or socket file
           name extension for Unix-domain
           connections.<indexterm><primary>port</></>
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

208
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-dbname" xreflabel="dbname">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
209 210
         <term><literal>dbname</literal></term>
         <listitem>
211
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
212
          The database name.  Defaults to be the same as the user name.
213
         </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
214 215
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
216

217
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-user" xreflabel="user">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
218 219
         <term><literal>user</literal></term>
         <listitem>
220
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
221 222 223
          <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> user name to connect as.
          Defaults to be the same as the operating system name of the user
          running the application.
224
         </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
225 226
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
227

228
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-password" xreflabel="password">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
229 230
         <term><literal>password</literal></term>
         <listitem>
231
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
232
          Password to be used if the server demands password authentication.
233
         </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
234 235
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
236

237
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-connect-timeout" xreflabel="connect_timeout">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
238 239
         <term><literal>connect_timeout</literal></term>
         <listitem>
240
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
241 242 243
          Maximum wait for connection, in seconds (write as a decimal integer
          string). Zero or not specified means wait indefinitely.  It is not
          recommended to use a timeout of less than 2 seconds.
244
         </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
245 246 247
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

248
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-options" xreflabel="options">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
249 250 251
         <term><literal>options</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
252 253 254 255 256
           Adds command-line options to send to the server at run-time.
           For example, setting this to <literal>-c geqo=off</> sets the
           session's value of the <varname>geqo</> parameter to
           <literal>off</>.  For a detailed discussion of the available
           options, consult <xref linkend="runtime-config">.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
257 258 259 260
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

261 262 263 264 265 266 267 268 269 270 271 272 273 274 275 276 277 278 279 280 281 282 283 284 285 286
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-application-name" xreflabel="application_name">
         <term><literal>application_name</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Specifies a value for the <xref linkend="guc-application-name">
           configuration parameter.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-fallback-application-name" xreflabel="fallback_application_name">
         <term><literal>fallback_application_name</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Specifies a fallback value for the <xref
           linkend="guc-application-name"> configuration parameter.
           This value will be used if no value has been given for
           <literal>application_name</> via a connection parameter or the
           <envar>PGAPPNAME</envar> environment variable.  Specifying
           a fallback name is useful in generic utility programs that
           wish to set a default application name but allow it to be
           overridden by the user.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

287 288 289 290
        <varlistentry id="libpq-keepalives" xreflabel="keepalives">
         <term><literal>keepalives</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
291 292 293 294
           Controls whether client-side TCP keepalives are used. The default
           value is 1, meaning on, but you can change this to 0, meaning off,
           if keepalives are not wanted.  This parameter is ignored for
           connections made via a Unix-domain socket.
295 296 297 298 299 300 301 302
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-keepalives-idle" xreflabel="keepalives_idle">
         <term><literal>keepalives_idle</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
303 304
           Controls the number of seconds of inactivity after which TCP should
           send a keepalive message to the server.  A value of zero uses the
305 306 307 308 309
           system default. This parameter is ignored for connections made via a
           Unix-domain socket, or if keepalives are disabled. It is only supported
           on systems where the <symbol>TCP_KEEPIDLE</> or <symbol>TCP_KEEPALIVE</>
           socket option is available, and on Windows; on other systems, it has no
           effect.
310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-keepalives-interval" xreflabel="keepalives_interval">
         <term><literal>keepalives_interval</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
318 319
           Controls the number of seconds after which a TCP keepalive message
           that is not acknowledged by the server should be retransmitted.  A
320 321 322 323 324
           value of zero uses the system default. This parameter is ignored for
           connections made via a Unix-domain socket, or if keepalives are disabled.
           It is only supported on systems where the <symbol>TCP_KEEPINTVL</>
           socket option is available, and on Windows; on other systems, it has no
           effect.
325 326 327 328 329 330 331 332
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-keepalives-count" xreflabel="keepalives_count">
         <term><literal>keepalives_count</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
333 334
           Controls the number of TCP keepalives that can be lost before the
           client's connection to the server is considered dead.  A value of
335 336 337 338
           zero uses the system default. This parameter is ignored for
           connections made via a Unix-domain socket, or if keepalives are disabled.
           It is only supported on systems where the <symbol>TCP_KEEPINTVL</>
           socket option is available; on other systems, it has no effect.
339 340 341 342
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

343
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-tty" xreflabel="tty">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
344 345
         <term><literal>tty</literal></term>
         <listitem>
346
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
347
          Ignored (formerly, this specified where to send server debug output).
348
         </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
349 350 351
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

352
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-sslmode" xreflabel="sslmode">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
353 354 355
         <term><literal>sslmode</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
356
           This option determines whether or with what priority a secure
357
           <acronym>SSL</> TCP/IP connection will be negotiated with the
358
           server. There are six modes:
359
          </para>
360

361 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 369
          <table id="libpq-connect-sslmode-options">
           <title><literal>sslmode</literal> options</title>
           <tgroup cols="2">
            <thead>
             <row>
              <entry>Option</entry>
              <entry>Description</entry>
             </row>
            </thead>
370

371
            <tbody>
372

373 374 375 376
             <row>
              <entry><literal>disable</></entry>
              <entry>only try a non-<acronym>SSL</> connection</entry>
             </row>
377

378 379 380 381
             <row>
              <entry><literal>allow</></entry>
              <entry>first try a non-<acronym>SSL</>
               connection;  if that fails, try an <acronym>SSL</>
382
               connection</entry>
383
             </row>
384

385 386 387 388 389 390
             <row>
              <entry><literal>prefer</> (default)</entry>
              <entry>first try an <acronym>SSL</> connection;  if
              that fails, try a non-<acronym>SSL</>
              connection</entry>
             </row>
391

392 393 394 395
             <row>
              <entry><literal>require</></entry>
              <entry>only try an <acronym>SSL</> connection</entry>
             </row>
396 397 398 399

             <row>
              <entry><literal>verify-ca</></entry>
              <entry>only try an <acronym>SSL</> connection, and verify that
400
              the server certificate is issued by a trusted <acronym>CA</>
401 402 403 404 405 406 407
              </entry>
             </row>

             <row>
              <entry><literal>verify-full</></entry>
              <entry>only try an <acronym>SSL</> connection, verify that
              the server certificate is issued by a trusted <acronym>CA</> and
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
408
              that the server host name matches that in the certificate</entry>
409 410
             </row>

411 412 413
            </tbody>
           </tgroup>
          </table>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
414

415 416 417 418 419
          <para>
           See <xref linkend="libpq-ssl"> for a detailed description of how
           these options work.
          </para>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
420
          <para>
421 422
           <literal>sslmode</> is ignored for Unix domain socket
           communication.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
423
           If <productname>PostgreSQL</> is compiled without SSL support,
424 425
           using options <literal>require</>, <literal>verify-ca</>, or
           <literal>verify-full</> will cause an error, while
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
426
           options <literal>allow</> and <literal>prefer</> will be
427
           accepted but <application>libpq</> will not actually attempt
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
428 429 430 431 432 433 434
           an <acronym>SSL</>
           connection.<indexterm><primary>SSL</><secondary
           sortas="libpq">with libpq</></indexterm>
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

435
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-requiressl" xreflabel="requiressl">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443 444 445 446 447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456
         <term><literal>requiressl</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           This option is deprecated in favor of the <literal>sslmode</>
           setting.
          </para>

          <para>
           If set to 1, an <acronym>SSL</acronym> connection to the server
           is required (this is equivalent to <literal>sslmode</>
           <literal>require</>).  <application>libpq</> will then refuse
           to connect if the server does not accept an
           <acronym>SSL</acronym> connection.  If set to 0 (default),
           <application>libpq</> will negotiate the connection type with
           the server (equivalent to <literal>sslmode</>
           <literal>prefer</>).  This option is only available if
           <productname>PostgreSQL</> is compiled with SSL support.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

457
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-sslcert" xreflabel="sslcert">
458 459 460 461
         <term><literal>sslcert</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           This parameter specifies the file name of the client SSL
462 463
           certificate, replacing the default
           <filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.crt</>.
464
           This parameter is ignored if an SSL connection is not made.
465 466 467 468
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

469
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-sslkey" xreflabel="sslkey">
470 471 472
         <term><literal>sslkey</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
473
           This parameter specifies the location for the secret key used for
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
474
           the client certificate. It can either specify a file name that will
475 476 477 478 479 480 481
           be used instead of the default
           <filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.key</>, or it can specify a key
           obtained from an external <quote>engine</> (engines are
           <productname>OpenSSL</> loadable modules).  An external engine
           specification should consist of a colon-separated engine name and
           an engine-specific key identifier.  This parameter is ignored if an
           SSL connection is not made.
482 483 484 485
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

486
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-sslrootcert" xreflabel="sslrootcert">
487 488 489
         <term><literal>sslrootcert</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
490 491 492 493 494
           This parameter specifies the name of a file containing SSL
           certificate authority (<acronym>CA</>) certificate(s).
           If the file exists, the server's certificate will be verified
           to be signed by one of these authorities.  The default is
           <filename>~/.postgresql/root.crt</>.
495 496 497 498
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

499
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-sslcrl" xreflabel="sslcrl">
500 501 502 503
         <term><literal>sslcrl</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           This parameter specifies the file name of the SSL certificate
504 505 506 507
           revocation list (CRL).  Certificates listed in this file, if it
           exists, will be rejected while attempting to authenticate the
           server's certificate.  The default is
           <filename>~/.postgresql/root.crl</>.
508 509 510 511
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

512 513 514 515 516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532 533
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-requirepeer" xreflabel="requirepeer">
         <term><literal>requirepeer</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           For Unix-domain socket connections, if this parameter is
           set, the client checks at the beginning of the connection
           that the server process runs under the specified user name,
           otherwise the connection is aborted with an error.  This
           parameter can be used to achieve the kind of server
           authentication that SSL certificates achieve on TCP/IP
           connections.  (Note that if the Unix-domain socket is
           in <filename>/tmp</filename> or another publically writable
           location, any user could start a server there.  Use this
           parameter to ensure that you are connected to a server run
           by a trusted user,
           e.g., <literal>requirepeer=postgres</literal>.)  This
           option is only supported on some platforms, currently
           Linux, FreeBSD, NetBSD, OpenBSD, and Solaris.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

534
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-krbsrvname" xreflabel="krbsrvname">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
535 536 537 538 539 540 541 542 543 544 545 546
         <term><literal>krbsrvname</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Kerberos service name to use when authenticating with Kerberos 5
           or GSSAPI.
           This must match the service name specified in the server
           configuration for Kerberos authentication to succeed. (See also
           <xref linkend="kerberos-auth"> and <xref linkend="gssapi-auth">.)
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

547
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-gsslib" xreflabel="gsslib">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
548 549 550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557
         <term><literal>gsslib</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           GSS library to use for GSSAPI authentication. Only used on Windows.
           Set to <literal>gssapi</literal> to force libpq to use the GSSAPI
           library for authentication instead of the default SSPI.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

558
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connect-service" xreflabel="service">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
559 560 561 562 563 564 565 566 567 568 569 570 571 572 573 574
         <term><literal>service</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Service name to use for additional parameters.  It specifies a service
           name in <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> that holds additional connection parameters.
           This allows applications to specify only a service name so connection parameters
           can be centrally maintained. See <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice">.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
       </variablelist>

       If  any  parameter is unspecified, then the corresponding
       environment variable (see <xref linkend="libpq-envars">)
       is checked. If the  environment  variable is not set either,
       then the indicated built-in defaults are used.
575
      </para>
576 577

      <para>
578
        If <literal>expand_dbname</literal> is non-zero and
579 580 581 582 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590 591 592 593
        <parameter>dbname</parameter> contains an <symbol>=</symbol> sign, it
        is taken as a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string in exactly the same way as
        if it had been passed to <function>PQconnectdb</function>(see below). Previously
        processed key words will be overridden by key words in the
        <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string.
      </para>

      <para>
        In general key words are processed from the beginning of these arrays in index
        order. The effect of this is that when key words are repeated, the last processed
        value is retained. Therefore, through careful placement of the
        <parameter>dbname</parameter> key word, it is possible to determine what may
        be overridden by a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string, and what may not.
      </para>

594 595 596
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

597
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconnectdb">
598 599 600 601 602
     <term><function>PQconnectdb</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectdb</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Makes a new connection to the database server.

603 604 605
<synopsis>
PGconn *PQconnectdb(const char *conninfo);
</synopsis>
606 607 608 609 610 611 612 613 614 615 616 617 618 619 620 621 622 623 624 625 626 627 628 629
      </para>

      <para>
       This function opens a new database connection using the parameters taken
       from the string <literal>conninfo</literal>.
      </para>

      <para>
       The passed string can be empty to use all default parameters, or it can
       contain one or more parameter settings separated by whitespace.
       Each parameter setting is in the form <literal>keyword = value</literal>.
       Spaces around the equal sign are optional. To write an empty value,
       or a value containing spaces, surround it with single quotes, e.g.,
       <literal>keyword = 'a value'</literal>. Single quotes and backslashes
       within the value must be escaped with a backslash, i.e.,
       <literal>\'</literal> and <literal>\\</literal>.
      </para>

      <para>
       The currently recognized parameter key words are the same as above.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

630
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetdblogin">
631 632 633 634
     <term><function>PQsetdbLogin</function><indexterm><primary>PQsetdbLogin</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Makes a new connection to the database server.
635
<synopsis>
636 637 638 639 640 641 642
PGconn *PQsetdbLogin(const char *pghost,
                     const char *pgport,
                     const char *pgoptions,
                     const char *pgtty,
                     const char *dbName,
                     const char *login,
                     const char *pwd);
643
</synopsis>
644
       </para>
645

646 647 648 649 650 651
       <para>
        This is the predecessor of <function>PQconnectdb</function> with a fixed
        set of parameters.  It has the same functionality except that the
        missing parameters will always take on default values.  Write <symbol>NULL</symbol> or an
        empty string for any one of the fixed parameters that is to be defaulted.
      </para>
652

653 654 655 656 657 658 659 660
      <para>
        If the <parameter>dbName</parameter> contains an <symbol>=</symbol> sign, it
        is taken as a <parameter>conninfo</parameter> string in exactly the same way as
        if it had been passed to <function>PQconnectdb</function>, and the remaining
        parameters are then applied as above.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
661

662
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetdb">
663
     <term><function>PQsetdb</function><indexterm><primary>PQsetdb</></></term>
664
     <listitem>
665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673 674 675
      <para>
   Makes a new connection to the database server.
<synopsis>
PGconn *PQsetdb(char *pghost,
                char *pgport,
                char *pgoptions,
                char *pgtty,
                char *dbName);
</synopsis>
     </para>

676
     <para>
677 678 679
      This is a macro that calls <function>PQsetdbLogin</function> with null pointers
      for the <parameter>login</> and <parameter>pwd</> parameters.  It is provided
      for backward compatibility with very old programs.
680 681 682
     </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
683

684
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconnectstartparams">
685
     <term><function>PQconnectStartParams</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectStartParams</></></term>
686 687
     <term><function>PQconnectStart</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectStart</></></term>
     <term><function>PQconnectPoll</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectPoll</></></term>
688
     <listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
689 690 691
      <para>
       <indexterm><primary>nonblocking connection</primary></indexterm>
       Make a connection to the database server in a nonblocking manner.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
692

693 694
<synopsis>
PGconn *PQconnectStartParams(const char **keywords, const char **values, int expand_dbname);
695

696
PGconn *PQconnectStart(const char *conninfo);
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
697

698 699
PostgresPollingStatusType PQconnectPoll(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
700
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
701

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
702
      <para>
703
       These three functions are used to open a connection to a database server such
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
704
       that your application's thread of execution is not blocked on remote I/O
705 706 707 708
       whilst doing so. The point of this approach is that the waits for I/O to
       complete can occur in the application's main loop, rather than down inside
       <function>PQconnectdbParams</> or <function>PQconnectdb</>, and so the
       application can manage this operation in parallel with other activities.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
709
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
710

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
711
      <para>
712 713
       With <function>PQconnectStartParams</function>, the database connection is made
       using the parameters taken from the <literal>keywords</literal> and
714 715
       <literal>values</literal> arrays, and controlled by <literal>expand_dbname</literal>,
       as described above for <function>PQconnectdbParams</function>.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
716
      </para>
717

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
718
      <para>
719 720 721 722 723 724 725 726
       With <function>PQconnectStart</function>, the database connection is made
       using the parameters taken from the string <literal>conninfo</literal> as
       described above for <function>PQconnectdb</function>.
      </para>

      <para>
       Neither <function>PQconnectStartParams</function> nor <function>PQconnectStart</function>
       nor <function>PQconnectPoll</function> will block, so long as a number of
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
727 728
       restrictions are met:
       <itemizedlist>
729 730
        <listitem>
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
731 732
          The <literal>hostaddr</> and <literal>host</> parameters are used appropriately to ensure that
          name and reverse name queries are not made. See the documentation of
733
          these parameters under <function>PQconnectdbParams</function> above for details.
734 735
         </para>
        </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
736

737 738
        <listitem>
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
739 740
          If you call <function>PQtrace</function>, ensure that the stream object
          into which you trace will not block.
741 742
         </para>
        </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
743

744 745
        <listitem>
         <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
746 747
          You ensure that the socket is in the appropriate state
          before calling <function>PQconnectPoll</function>, as described below.
748 749
         </para>
        </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
750 751
       </itemizedlist>
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
752

753 754 755 756 757
      <para>
       Note: use of <function>PQconnectStartParams</> is analogous to
       <function>PQconnectStart</> shown below.
      </para>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
758 759 760 761 762 763 764 765
      <para>
       To begin a nonblocking connection request, call <literal>conn = PQconnectStart("<replaceable>connection_info_string</>")</literal>.
       If <varname>conn</varname> is null, then <application>libpq</> has been unable to allocate a new <structname>PGconn</>
       structure. Otherwise, a valid <structname>PGconn</> pointer is returned (though not yet
       representing a valid connection to the database). On return from
       <function>PQconnectStart</function>, call <literal>status = PQstatus(conn)</literal>. If <varname>status</varname> equals
       <symbol>CONNECTION_BAD</symbol>, <function>PQconnectStart</function> has failed.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
766

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
767 768 769 770 771 772 773 774 775 776 777 778 779 780 781 782 783 784 785 786 787 788
      <para>
       If <function>PQconnectStart</> succeeds, the next stage is to poll
       <application>libpq</> so that it can proceed with the connection sequence.
       Use <function>PQsocket(conn)</function> to obtain the descriptor of the
       socket underlying the database connection.
       Loop thus: If <function>PQconnectPoll(conn)</function> last returned
       <symbol>PGRES_POLLING_READING</symbol>, wait until the socket is ready to
       read (as indicated by <function>select()</>, <function>poll()</>, or
       similar system function).
       Then call <function>PQconnectPoll(conn)</function> again.
       Conversely, if <function>PQconnectPoll(conn)</function> last returned
       <symbol>PGRES_POLLING_WRITING</symbol>, wait until the socket is ready
       to write, then call <function>PQconnectPoll(conn)</function> again.
       If you have yet to call
       <function>PQconnectPoll</function>, i.e., just after the call to
       <function>PQconnectStart</function>, behave as if it last returned
       <symbol>PGRES_POLLING_WRITING</symbol>.  Continue this loop until
       <function>PQconnectPoll(conn)</function> returns
       <symbol>PGRES_POLLING_FAILED</symbol>, indicating the connection procedure
       has failed, or <symbol>PGRES_POLLING_OK</symbol>, indicating the connection
       has been successfully made.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
789

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
790 791 792 793 794 795 796 797 798
      <para>
       At any time during connection, the status of the connection can be
       checked by calling <function>PQstatus</>. If this gives <symbol>CONNECTION_BAD</>, then the
       connection procedure has failed; if it gives <function>CONNECTION_OK</>, then the
       connection is ready.  Both of these states are equally detectable
       from the return value of <function>PQconnectPoll</>, described above. Other states might also occur
       during (and only during) an asynchronous connection procedure. These
       indicate the current stage of the connection procedure and might be useful
       to provide feedback to the user for example. These statuses are:
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
799

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
800
       <variablelist>
801
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-started">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
802 803 804 805 806 807 808
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_STARTED</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Waiting for connection to be made.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
809

810
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-made">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
811 812 813 814 815 816 817
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_MADE</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Connection OK; waiting to send.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
818

819
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-awaiting-response">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
820 821 822 823 824 825 826
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_AWAITING_RESPONSE</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Waiting for a response from the server.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
827

828
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-auth-ok">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
829 830 831 832 833 834 835
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_AUTH_OK</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Received authentication; waiting for backend start-up to finish.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
836

837
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-ssl-startup">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
838 839 840 841 842 843 844
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_SSL_STARTUP</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Negotiating SSL encryption.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
845

846
        <varlistentry id="libpq-connection-setenv">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854
         <term><symbol>CONNECTION_SETENV</symbol></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           Negotiating environment-driven parameter settings.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
       </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
855

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
856 857 858 859
       Note that, although these constants will remain (in order to maintain
       compatibility), an application should never rely upon these occurring in a
       particular order, or at all, or on the status always being one of these
       documented values. An application might do something like this:
860 861 862 863 864 865 866 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876
<programlisting>
switch(PQstatus(conn))
{
        case CONNECTION_STARTED:
            feedback = "Connecting...";
            break;

        case CONNECTION_MADE:
            feedback = "Connected to server...";
            break;
.
.
.
        default:
            feedback = "Connecting...";
}
</programlisting>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
877
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
878

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
879 880 881 882 883 884 885 886
      <para>
       The <literal>connect_timeout</literal> connection parameter is ignored
       when using <function>PQconnectPoll</function>; it is the application's
       responsibility to decide whether an excessive amount of time has elapsed.
       Otherwise, <function>PQconnectStart</function> followed by a
       <function>PQconnectPoll</function> loop is equivalent to
       <function>PQconnectdb</function>.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
887

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
888 889 890 891 892 893 894 895
      <para>
       Note that if <function>PQconnectStart</function> returns a non-null pointer, you must call
       <function>PQfinish</function> when you are finished with it, in order to dispose of
       the structure and any associated memory blocks. This must be done even if
       the connection attempt fails or is abandoned.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
896

897
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconndefaults">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
898 899 900 901
     <term><function>PQconndefaults</function><indexterm><primary>PQconndefaults</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the default connection options.
902 903 904 905 906 907 908 909 910 911
<synopsis>
PQconninfoOption *PQconndefaults(void);

typedef struct
{
    char   *keyword;   /* The keyword of the option */
    char   *envvar;    /* Fallback environment variable name */
    char   *compiled;  /* Fallback compiled in default value */
    char   *val;       /* Option's current value, or NULL */
    char   *label;     /* Label for field in connect dialog */
912
    char   *dispchar;  /* Indicates how to display this field
913 914 915 916 917 918 919
                          in a connect dialog. Values are:
                          ""        Display entered value as is
                          "*"       Password field - hide value
                          "D"       Debug option - don't show by default */
    int     dispsize;  /* Field size in characters for dialog */
} PQconninfoOption;
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
920
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
921

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
922 923 924 925 926 927 928 929 930 931 932
      <para>
       Returns a connection options array.  This can be used to determine
       all possible <function>PQconnectdb</function> options and their
       current default values.  The return value points to an array of
       <structname>PQconninfoOption</structname> structures, which ends
       with an entry having a null <structfield>keyword</> pointer.  The
       null pointer is returned if memory could not be allocated. Note that
       the current default values (<structfield>val</structfield> fields)
       will depend on environment variables and other context.  Callers
       must treat the connection options data as read-only.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
933

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
934 935 936 937 938
      <para>
       After processing the options array, free it by passing it to
       <function>PQconninfoFree</function>.  If this is not done, a small amount of memory
       is leaked for each call to <function>PQconndefaults</function>.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
939

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
940 941
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
942

943
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconninfoparse">
944 945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955
     <term><function>PQconninfoParse</function><indexterm><primary>PQconninfoParse</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns parsed connection options from the provided connection string.

<synopsis>
PQconninfoOption *PQconninfoParse(const char *conninfo, char **errmsg);
</synopsis>
      </para>

      <para>
       Parses a connection string and returns the resulting options as an
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
956
       array; or returns <symbol>NULL</> if there is a problem with the connection
957 958 959 960 961 962 963 964 965 966 967 968 969
       string.  This can be used to determine
       the <function>PQconnectdb</function> options in the provided
       connection string.  The return value points to an array of
       <structname>PQconninfoOption</structname> structures, which ends
       with an entry having a null <structfield>keyword</> pointer.
      </para>

      <para>
       Note that only options explicitly specified in the string will have
       values set in the result array; no defaults are inserted.
      </para>

      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
970 971
       If <literal>errmsg</> is not <symbol>NULL</>, then <literal>*errmsg</> is set
       to <symbol>NULL</> on success, else to a <function>malloc</>'d error string explaining
972
       the problem.  (It is also possible for <literal>*errmsg</> to be
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
973
       set to <symbol>NULL</> even when <symbol>NULL</> is returned; this indicates an out-of-memory
974 975 976 977 978 979 980
       situation.)
      </para>

      <para>
       After processing the options array, free it by passing it to
       <function>PQconninfoFree</function>.  If this is not done, some memory
       is leaked for each call to <function>PQconninfoParse</function>.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
981
       Conversely, if an error occurs and <literal>errmsg</> is not <symbol>NULL</>,
982 983 984 985 986 987
       be sure to free the error string using <function>PQfreemem</>.
      </para>

   </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

988
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfinish">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
989 990 991 992 993
     <term><function>PQfinish</function><indexterm><primary>PQfinish</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Closes  the  connection to the server.  Also frees
       memory used by the <structname>PGconn</structname> object.
994 995 996
<synopsis>
void PQfinish(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
997
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
998

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007
      <para>
       Note that even if the server connection attempt fails (as
       indicated by <function>PQstatus</function>), the application should call <function>PQfinish</function>
       to free the memory used by the <structname>PGconn</structname> object.
       The <structname>PGconn</> pointer must not be used again after
       <function>PQfinish</function> has been called.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1008

1009
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqreset">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1010 1011 1012 1013
     <term><function>PQreset</function><indexterm><primary>PQreset</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Resets the communication channel to the server.
1014 1015 1016
<synopsis>
void PQreset(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1017
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1018

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1019 1020 1021 1022 1023 1024
      <para>
       This function will close the connection
       to the server and attempt to  reestablish  a  new
       connection to the same server, using all the same
       parameters previously used.  This might be useful for
       error recovery if a working connection is lost.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1025
      </para>
1026 1027 1028
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1029
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresetstart">
1030 1031
     <term><function>PQresetStart</function><indexterm><primary>PQresetStart</></></term>
     <term><function>PQresetPoll</function><indexterm><primary>PQresetPoll</></></term>
1032
     <listitem>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1033
      <para>
1034 1035
       Reset the communication channel to the server, in a nonblocking manner.

1036 1037 1038 1039 1040
<synopsis>
int PQresetStart(PGconn *conn);

PostgresPollingStatusType PQresetPoll(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1041 1042 1043
      </para>

      <para>
1044 1045 1046 1047 1048
       These functions will close the connection to the server and attempt to
       reestablish a new connection to the same server, using all the same
       parameters previously used. This can be useful for error recovery if a
       working connection is lost. They differ from <function>PQreset</function> (above) in that they
       act in a nonblocking manner. These functions suffer from the same
1049 1050
       restrictions as <function>PQconnectStartParams</>, <function>PQconnectStart</>
       and <function>PQconnectPoll</>.
B
 
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1051 1052
      </para>

1053
      <para>
1054 1055 1056 1057 1058
       To initiate a connection reset, call
       <function>PQresetStart</function>. If it returns 0, the reset has
       failed. If it returns 1, poll the reset using
       <function>PQresetPoll</function> in exactly the same way as you
       would create the connection using <function>PQconnectPoll</function>.
1059 1060 1061 1062
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1063
   </variablelist>
1064 1065
  </para>
 </sect1>
1066

1067 1068
 <sect1 id="libpq-status">
  <title>Connection Status Functions</title>
1069

1070 1071 1072 1073
  <para>
   These functions can be used to interrogate the status
   of an existing database connection object.
  </para>
T
Tom Lane 已提交
1074

1075
  <tip>
1076
   <para>
1077 1078 1079 1080 1081
    <indexterm><primary>libpq-fe.h</></>
    <indexterm><primary>libpq-int.h</></>
    <application>libpq</application> application programmers should be careful to
    maintain the <structname>PGconn</structname> abstraction.  Use the accessor
    functions described below to get at the contents of <structname>PGconn</structname>.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1082
    Reference to internal <structname>PGconn</structname> fields using
1083 1084
    <filename>libpq-int.h</> is not recommended because they are subject to change
    in the future.
1085
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1086
  </tip>
1087

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1088 1089 1090
  <para>
   The following functions return parameter values established at connection.
   These values are fixed for the life of the <structname>PGconn</> object.
1091

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1092
   <variablelist>
1093
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqdb">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1094 1095 1096 1097 1098 1099
     <term>
      <function>PQdb</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQdb</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1100

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1101 1102 1103
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the database name of the connection.
1104 1105 1106
<synopsis>
char *PQdb(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1107 1108 1109
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1110

1111
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pquser">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1112 1113 1114 1115 1116 1117
     <term>
      <function>PQuser</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQuser</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1118

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1119 1120 1121
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the user name of the connection.
1122 1123 1124
<synopsis>
char *PQuser(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1125 1126 1127
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1128

1129
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqpass">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135
     <term>
      <function>PQpass</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQpass</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1136

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1137 1138 1139
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the password of the connection.
1140 1141 1142
<synopsis>
char *PQpass(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1143 1144 1145
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1146

1147
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqhost">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153
     <term>
      <function>PQhost</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQhost</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1154

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1155 1156 1157
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the server host name of the connection.
1158 1159 1160
<synopsis>
char *PQhost(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1161 1162 1163 1164
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1165
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqport">
1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171
     <term>
      <function>PQport</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQport</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1172

1173 1174 1175
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the port of the connection.
1176

1177 1178 1179
<synopsis>
char *PQport(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1180 1181 1182
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1183

1184
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqtty">
1185 1186 1187 1188 1189 1190
     <term>
      <function>PQtty</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQtty</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1191

1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the debug <acronym>TTY</acronym> of the connection.
       (This is obsolete, since the server no longer pays attention
       to the <acronym>TTY</acronym> setting, but the function remains
       for backwards compatibility.)

1199 1200 1201
<synopsis>
char *PQtty(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1202 1203 1204 1205
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1206
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqoptions">
1207 1208 1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216
     <term>
      <function>PQoptions</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQoptions</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the command-line options passed in the connection request.
1217 1218 1219
<synopsis>
char *PQoptions(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1220 1221 1222 1223
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
1224
  </para>
1225

1226
  <para>
1227 1228
   The following functions return status data that can change as operations
   are executed on the <structname>PGconn</> object.
1229

1230
   <variablelist>
1231
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqstatus">
1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237
     <term>
      <function>PQstatus</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQstatus</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
1238

1239 1240
     <listitem>
      <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1241
       Returns the status of the connection.
1242 1243 1244
<synopsis>
ConnStatusType PQstatus(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1245
      </para>
1246

1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256 1257 1258 1259 1260
      <para>
       The status can be one of a number of values.  However, only two of
       these are seen outside of an asynchronous connection procedure:
       <literal>CONNECTION_OK</literal> and
       <literal>CONNECTION_BAD</literal>. A good connection to the database
       has the status <literal>CONNECTION_OK</literal>.  A failed
       connection attempt is signaled by status
       <literal>CONNECTION_BAD</literal>.  Ordinarily, an OK status will
       remain so until <function>PQfinish</function>, but a communications
       failure might result in the status changing to
       <literal>CONNECTION_BAD</literal> prematurely.  In that case the
       application could try to recover by calling
       <function>PQreset</function>.
      </para>
1261

1262
      <para>
1263 1264 1265
       See the entry for <function>PQconnectStartParams</>, <function>PQconnectStart</>
       and <function>PQconnectPoll</> with regards to other status codes that
       might be seen.
1266 1267 1268
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1269

1270
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqtransactionstatus">
1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276
     <term>
      <function>PQtransactionStatus</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQtransactionStatus</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1277

1278 1279 1280 1281
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the current in-transaction status of the server.

1282 1283 1284
<synopsis>
PGTransactionStatusType PQtransactionStatus(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293

       The status can be <literal>PQTRANS_IDLE</literal> (currently idle),
       <literal>PQTRANS_ACTIVE</literal> (a command is in progress),
       <literal>PQTRANS_INTRANS</literal> (idle, in a valid transaction block),
       or <literal>PQTRANS_INERROR</literal> (idle, in a failed transaction block).
       <literal>PQTRANS_UNKNOWN</literal> is reported if the connection is bad.
       <literal>PQTRANS_ACTIVE</literal> is reported only when a query
       has been sent to the server and not yet completed.
      </para>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
1294

1295 1296 1297 1298 1299 1300 1301 1302
      <caution>
       <para>
        <function>PQtransactionStatus</> will give incorrect results when using
        a <productname>PostgreSQL</> 7.3 server that has the parameter <literal>autocommit</>
        set to off.  The server-side autocommit feature has been
        deprecated and does not exist in later server versions.
       </para>
      </caution>
1303 1304
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1305

1306
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqparameterstatus">
1307 1308 1309 1310 1311 1312
     <term>
      <function>PQparameterStatus</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQparameterStatus</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1313

1314 1315 1316
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Looks up a current parameter setting of the server.
T
Tom Lane 已提交
1317

1318 1319 1320
<synopsis>
const char *PQparameterStatus(const PGconn *conn, const char *paramName);
</synopsis>
1321

1322 1323 1324 1325 1326 1327
       Certain parameter values are reported by the server automatically at
       connection startup or whenever their values change.
       <function>PQparameterStatus</> can be used to interrogate these settings.
       It returns the current value of a parameter if known, or <symbol>NULL</symbol>
       if the parameter is not known.
      </para>
1328 1329

      <para>
1330 1331 1332 1333
       Parameters reported as of the current release include
       <literal>server_version</>,
       <literal>server_encoding</>,
       <literal>client_encoding</>,
1334
       <literal>application_name</>,
1335 1336 1337
       <literal>is_superuser</>,
       <literal>session_authorization</>,
       <literal>DateStyle</>,
1338
       <literal>IntervalStyle</>,
1339 1340 1341 1342 1343 1344
       <literal>TimeZone</>,
       <literal>integer_datetimes</>, and
       <literal>standard_conforming_strings</>.
       (<literal>server_encoding</>, <literal>TimeZone</>, and
       <literal>integer_datetimes</> were not reported by releases before 8.0;
       <literal>standard_conforming_strings</> was not reported by releases
1345 1346
       before 8.1;
       <literal>IntervalStyle</> was not reported by releases before 8.4;
1347
       <literal>application_name</> was not reported by releases before 9.0.)
1348 1349 1350 1351 1352
       Note that
       <literal>server_version</>,
       <literal>server_encoding</> and
       <literal>integer_datetimes</>
       cannot change after startup.
1353 1354 1355
      </para>

      <para>
1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373 1374 1375 1376 1377 1378 1379 1380
       Pre-3.0-protocol servers do not report parameter settings, but
       <application>libpq</> includes logic to obtain values for
       <literal>server_version</> and <literal>client_encoding</> anyway.
       Applications are encouraged to use <function>PQparameterStatus</>
       rather than <foreignphrase>ad hoc</> code to determine these values.
       (Beware however that on a pre-3.0 connection, changing
       <literal>client_encoding</> via <command>SET</> after connection
       startup will not be reflected by <function>PQparameterStatus</>.)
       For <literal>server_version</>, see also
       <function>PQserverVersion</>, which returns the information in a
       numeric form that is much easier to compare against.
      </para>

      <para>
       If no value for <literal>standard_conforming_strings</> is reported,
       applications can assume it is <literal>off</>, that is, backslashes
       are treated as escapes in string literals.  Also, the presence of
       this parameter can be taken as an indication that the escape string
       syntax (<literal>E'...'</>) is accepted.
      </para>

      <para>
       Although the returned pointer is declared <literal>const</>, it in fact
       points to mutable storage associated with the <literal>PGconn</> structure.
       It is unwise to assume the pointer will remain valid across queries.
1381 1382
      </para>
     </listitem>
1383
    </varlistentry>
1384

1385
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqprotocolversion">
1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391
     <term>
      <function>PQprotocolVersion</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQprotocolVersion</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
1392

1393 1394 1395
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Interrogates the frontend/backend protocol being used.
1396 1397 1398
<synopsis>
int PQprotocolVersion(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1399 1400 1401 1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410
       Applications might wish to use this to determine whether certain
       features are supported.  Currently, the possible values are 2 (2.0
       protocol), 3 (3.0 protocol), or zero (connection bad).  This will
       not change after connection startup is complete, but it could
       theoretically change during a connection reset.  The 3.0 protocol
       will normally be used when communicating with
       <productname>PostgreSQL</> 7.4 or later servers; pre-7.4 servers
       support only protocol 2.0.  (Protocol 1.0 is obsolete and not
       supported by <application>libpq</application>.)
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1411

1412
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqserverversion">
1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419 1420 1421 1422
     <term>
      <function>PQserverVersion</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQserverVersion</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns an integer representing the backend version.
1423 1424 1425
<synopsis>
int PQserverVersion(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431 1432 1433 1434 1435
       Applications might use this to determine the version of the database
       server they are connected to. The number is formed by converting
       the major, minor, and revision numbers into two-decimal-digit
       numbers and appending them together. For example, version 8.1.5
       will be returned as 80105, and version 8.2 will be returned as
       80200 (leading zeroes are not shown).  Zero is returned if the
       connection is bad.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
1436

1437
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqerrormessage">
1438 1439 1440 1441 1442 1443 1444
     <term>
      <function>PQerrorMessage</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQerrorMessage</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

1445 1446
     <listitem>
      <para>
1447 1448 1449
       <indexterm><primary>error message</></> Returns the error message
       most recently generated by an operation on the connection.

1450 1451 1452
<synopsis>
char *PQerrorMessage(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1453

1454 1455 1456
      </para>

      <para>
1457
       Nearly all <application>libpq</> functions will set a message for
1458 1459
       <function>PQerrorMessage</function> if they fail.  Note that by
       <application>libpq</application> convention, a nonempty
1460 1461 1462 1463 1464
       <function>PQerrorMessage</function> result can be multiple lines,
       and will include a trailing newline. The caller should not free
       the result directly. It will be freed when the associated
       <structname>PGconn</> handle is passed to
       <function>PQfinish</function>.  The result string should not be
1465
       expected to remain the same across operations on the
T
Tom Lane 已提交
1466
       <literal>PGconn</> structure.
1467 1468
      </para>
     </listitem>
1469
    </varlistentry>
1470

1471
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsocket">
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1472
     <term><function>PQsocket</function><indexterm><primary>PQsocket</></></term>
1473 1474
     <listitem>
      <para>
1475 1476 1477
       Obtains the file descriptor number of the connection socket to
       the server.  A valid descriptor will be greater than or equal
       to 0; a result of -1 indicates that no server connection is
1478 1479
       currently open.  (This will not change during normal operation,
       but could change during connection setup or reset.)
1480

1481 1482 1483
<synopsis>
int PQsocket(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1484

1485 1486 1487 1488
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1489
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqbackendpid">
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1490
     <term><function>PQbackendPID</function><indexterm><primary>PQbackendPID</></></term>
1491 1492
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1493 1494 1495 1496
       Returns the process <acronym>ID</acronym>
       (PID)<indexterm><primary>PID</><secondary>determining PID of
       server process</><tertiary>in libpq</></> of the backend server
       process handling this connection.
1497

1498 1499 1500
<synopsis>
int PQbackendPID(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1501 1502 1503
      </para>

      <para>
1504
       The backend <acronym>PID</acronym> is useful for debugging
1505 1506
       purposes and for comparison to <command>NOTIFY</command>
       messages (which include the <acronym>PID</acronym> of the
1507 1508 1509
       notifying backend process).  Note that the
       <acronym>PID</acronym> belongs to a process executing on the
       database server host, not the local host!
1510 1511
      </para>
     </listitem>
1512
    </varlistentry>
1513

1514 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 1520 1521 1522 1523 1524 1525 1526 1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 1540 1541 1542 1543 1544 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 1555 1556 1557 1558 1559 1560 1561 1562 1563 1564 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 1575 1576 1577 1578 1579 1580 1581
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqpingparams">
     <term><function>PQpingParams</function><indexterm><primary>PQpingParams</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       <function>PQpingParams</function> indicates the status of the
       server.  The currently recognized parameter key words are the
       same as <function>PQconnectParams</>.

<synopsis>
PGPing PQpingParams(const char **keywords, const char **values, int expand_dbname);
</synopsis>

       It returns one of the following values:

       <variablelist>
        <varlistentry id="libpq-pqpingparams-pqaccess">
         <term><literal>PQACCESS</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           The server is running and allows access.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-pqpingparams-pqreject">
         <term><literal>PQREJECT</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           The server is running but rejected a connection request.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>

        <varlistentry id="libpq-pqpingparams-pqnoresponse">
         <term><literal>PQNORESPONSE</literal></term>
         <listitem>
          <para>
           The server did not respond.
          </para>
         </listitem>
        </varlistentry>
       </variablelist>

      </para>

     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqping">
     <term><function>PQping</function><indexterm><primary>PQping</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the status of the server.

<synopsis>
PGPing PQping(const char *conninfo);
</synopsis>
      </para>

      <para>
       This function uses the same <literal>conninfo</literal> parameter
       key words as <function>PQconnectdb</>.  It returns the same
       values as <function>PQpingParams</> above.
      </para>

     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1582
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconnectionneedspassword">
1583 1584 1585 1586 1587 1588 1589
     <term><function>PQconnectionNeedsPassword</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectionNeedsPassword</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns true (1) if the connection authentication method
       required a password, but none was available.
       Returns false (0) if not.

1590 1591 1592
<synopsis>
int PQconnectionNeedsPassword(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1593 1594 1595 1596 1597 1598 1599 1600 1601
      </para>

      <para>
       This function can be applied after a failed connection attempt
       to decide whether to prompt the user for a password.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1602
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconnectionusedpassword">
1603 1604 1605 1606
     <term><function>PQconnectionUsedPassword</function><indexterm><primary>PQconnectionUsedPassword</></></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns true (1) if the connection authentication method
1607
       used a password. Returns false (0) if not.
1608

1609 1610 1611
<synopsis>
int PQconnectionUsedPassword(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1612 1613 1614
      </para>

      <para>
1615 1616
       This function can be applied after either a failed or successful
       connection attempt to detect whether the server demanded a password.
1617 1618 1619 1620
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

1621
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetssl">
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1622
     <term><function>PQgetssl</function><indexterm><primary>PQgetssl</></></term>
1623 1624
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1625
       <indexterm><primary>SSL</><secondary sortas="libpq">in libpq</secondary></indexterm>
1626
       Returns the SSL structure used in the connection, or null
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1627
       if SSL is not in use.
1628

1629 1630 1631
<synopsis>
SSL *PQgetssl(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
1632 1633 1634 1635 1636 1637
      </para>

      <para>
       This structure can be used to verify encryption levels, check server
       certificates, and more. Refer to the <productname>OpenSSL</>
       documentation for information about this structure.
1638
      </para>
1639

1640
      <para>
1641
       You must define <symbol>USE_SSL</symbol> in order to get the
1642 1643 1644
       correct prototype for this function. Doing so will also
       automatically include <filename>ssl.h</filename> from
       <productname>OpenSSL</productname>.
1645 1646
      </para>
     </listitem>
1647
    </varlistentry>
1648

1649 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 1655
   </variablelist>
  </para>

 </sect1>

 <sect1 id="libpq-exec">
  <title>Command Execution Functions</title>
1656

1657 1658 1659 1660 1661
  <para>
   Once a connection to a database server has been successfully
   established, the functions described here are used to perform
   SQL queries and commands.
  </para>
1662

1663 1664
  <sect2 id="libpq-exec-main">
   <title>Main Functions</title>
1665

1666 1667
   <para>
    <variablelist>
1668
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqexec">
1669 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674
      <term>
       <function>PQexec</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQexec</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1675

1676 1677 1678 1679
      <listitem>
       <para>
        Submits a command to the server and waits for the result.

1680 1681 1682
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQexec(PGconn *conn, const char *command);
</synopsis>
1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711
       </para>

       <para>
        Returns a <structname>PGresult</structname> pointer or possibly a null
        pointer.  A non-null pointer will generally be returned except in
        out-of-memory conditions or serious errors such as inability to send
        the command to the server.  If a null pointer is returned, it should
        be treated like a <symbol>PGRES_FATAL_ERROR</symbol> result.  Use
        <function>PQerrorMessage</function> to get more information about such
        errors.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
    </variablelist>

    It is allowed to include multiple SQL commands (separated by semicolons)
    in the command string.  Multiple queries sent in a single
    <function>PQexec</> call are processed in a single transaction, unless
    there are explicit <command>BEGIN</command>/<command>COMMIT</command>
    commands included in the query string to divide it into multiple
    transactions.  Note however that the returned
    <structname>PGresult</structname> structure describes only the result
    of the last command executed from the string.  Should one of the
    commands fail, processing of the string stops with it and the returned
    <structname>PGresult</structname> describes the error condition.
   </para>

   <para>
    <variablelist>
1712
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqexecparams">
1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718 1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724
      <term>
       <function>PQexecParams</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQexecParams</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Submits a command to the server and waits for the result,
        with the ability to pass parameters separately from the SQL
        command text.
1725

1726 1727 1728 1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQexecParams(PGconn *conn,
                       const char *command,
                       int nParams,
                       const Oid *paramTypes,
                       const char * const *paramValues,
                       const int *paramLengths,
                       const int *paramFormats,
                       int resultFormat);
</synopsis>
1736
       </para>
1737

1738 1739 1740 1741 1742 1743 1744
       <para>
        <function>PQexecParams</> is like <function>PQexec</>, but offers additional
        functionality: parameter values can be specified separately from the command
        string proper, and query results can be requested in either text or binary
        format.  <function>PQexecParams</> is supported only in protocol 3.0 and later
        connections; it will fail when using protocol 2.0.
       </para>
1745

1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753 1754 1755 1756 1757 1758 1759 1760 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1766 1767 1768 1769 1770 1771 1772 1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785 1786 1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792 1793 1794 1795 1796 1797 1798 1799 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 1805 1806 1807 1808 1809 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 1830
       <para>
        The function arguments are:

        <variablelist>
         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>conn</parameter></term>

          <listitem>
           <para>
            The connection object to send the command through.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>command</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The SQL command string to be executed. If parameters are used,
            they are referred to in the command string as <literal>$1</>,
            <literal>$2</>, etc.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>nParams</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The number of parameters supplied; it is the length of the arrays
            <parameter>paramTypes[]</>, <parameter>paramValues[]</>,
            <parameter>paramLengths[]</>, and <parameter>paramFormats[]</>. (The
            array pointers can be <symbol>NULL</symbol> when <parameter>nParams</>
            is zero.)
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>paramTypes[]</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Specifies, by OID, the data types to be assigned to the
            parameter symbols.  If <parameter>paramTypes</> is
            <symbol>NULL</symbol>, or any particular element in the array
            is zero, the server infers a data type for the parameter symbol
            in the same way it would do for an untyped literal string.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>paramValues[]</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Specifies the actual values of the parameters.  A null pointer
            in this array means the corresponding parameter is null;
            otherwise the pointer points to a zero-terminated text string
            (for text format) or binary data in the format expected by the
            server (for binary format).
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>paramLengths[]</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Specifies the actual data lengths of binary-format parameters.
            It is ignored for null parameters and text-format parameters.
            The array pointer can be null when there are no binary parameters.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>paramFormats[]</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Specifies whether parameters are text (put a zero in the
            array entry for the corresponding parameter) or binary (put
            a one in the array entry for the corresponding parameter).
            If the array pointer is null then all parameters are presumed
            to be text strings.
           </para>
1831
           <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
1832
            Values passed in binary format require knowledge of
1833 1834 1835 1836
            the internal representation expected by the backend.
            For example, integers must be passed in network byte
            order.  Passing <type>numeric</> values requires
            knowledge of the server storage format, as implemented
1837 1838 1839
            in
            <filename>src/backend/utils/adt/numeric.c::numeric_send()</> and
            <filename>src/backend/utils/adt/numeric.c::numeric_recv()</>.
1840
           </para>
1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

         <varlistentry>
          <term><parameter>resultFormat</parameter></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Specify zero to obtain results in text format, or one to obtain
            results in binary format.  (There is not currently a provision
            to obtain different result columns in different formats,
            although that is possible in the underlying protocol.)
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
        </variablelist>
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
    </variablelist>
   </para>
1861

1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867
   <para>
    The primary advantage of <function>PQexecParams</> over
    <function>PQexec</> is that parameter values can be separated from the
    command string, thus avoiding the need for tedious and error-prone
    quoting and escaping.
   </para>
1868

1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875
   <para>
    Unlike <function>PQexec</>, <function>PQexecParams</> allows at most
    one SQL command in the given string.  (There can be semicolons in it,
    but not more than one nonempty command.)  This is a limitation of the
    underlying protocol, but has some usefulness as an extra defense against
    SQL-injection attacks.
   </para>
1876

1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884
   <tip>
    <para>
     Specifying parameter types via OIDs is tedious, particularly if you prefer
     not to hard-wire particular OID values into your program.  However, you can
     avoid doing so even in cases where the server by itself cannot determine the
     type of the parameter, or chooses a different type than you want.  In the
     SQL command text, attach an explicit cast to the parameter symbol to show what
     data type you will send.  For example:
1885
<programlisting>
1886
SELECT * FROM mytable WHERE x = $1::bigint;
1887
</programlisting>
1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898
     This forces parameter <literal>$1</> to be treated as <type>bigint</>, whereas
     by default it would be assigned the same type as <literal>x</>.  Forcing the
     parameter type decision, either this way or by specifying a numeric type OID,
     is strongly recommended when sending parameter values in binary format, because
     binary format has less redundancy than text format and so there is less chance
     that the server will detect a type mismatch mistake for you.
    </para>
   </tip>

   <para>
    <variablelist>
1899
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqprepare">
1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 1905 1906 1907 1908 1909
      <term><function>PQprepare</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQprepare</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Submits a request to create a prepared statement with the
        given parameters, and waits for completion.
1910 1911 1912 1913 1914 1915 1916
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQprepare(PGconn *conn,
                    const char *stmtName,
                    const char *query,
                    int nParams,
                    const Oid *paramTypes);
</synopsis>
1917 1918 1919 1920 1921 1922 1923 1924 1925 1926 1927
       </para>

       <para>
        <function>PQprepare</> creates a prepared statement for later
        execution with <function>PQexecPrepared</>.  This feature allows
        commands that will be used repeatedly to be parsed and planned just
        once, rather than each time they are executed.
        <function>PQprepare</> is supported only in protocol 3.0 and later
        connections; it will fail when using protocol 2.0.
       </para>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1928 1929 1930 1931 1932 1933 1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940 1941 1942 1943 1944 1945 1946 1947 1948 1949 1950
       <para>
        The function creates a prepared statement named
        <parameter>stmtName</> from the <parameter>query</> string, which
        must contain a single SQL command.  <parameter>stmtName</> can be
        <literal>""</> to create an unnamed statement, in which case any
        pre-existing unnamed statement is automatically replaced; otherwise
        it is an error if the statement name is already defined in the
        current session.  If any parameters are used, they are referred
        to in the query as <literal>$1</>, <literal>$2</>, etc.
        <parameter>nParams</> is the number of parameters for which types
        are pre-specified in the array <parameter>paramTypes[]</>.  (The
        array pointer can be <symbol>NULL</symbol> when
        <parameter>nParams</> is zero.) <parameter>paramTypes[]</>
        specifies, by OID, the data types to be assigned to the parameter
        symbols.  If <parameter>paramTypes</> is <symbol>NULL</symbol>,
        or any particular element in the array is zero, the server assigns
        a data type to the parameter symbol in the same way it would do
        for an untyped literal string.  Also, the query can use parameter
        symbols with numbers higher than <parameter>nParams</>; data types
        will be inferred for these symbols as well.  (See
        <function>PQdescribePrepared</function> for a means to find out
        what data types were inferred.)
       </para>
1951

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1952 1953 1954 1955 1956 1957 1958 1959 1960 1961 1962 1963 1964
       <para>
        As with <function>PQexec</>, the result is normally a
        <structname>PGresult</structname> object whose contents indicate
        server-side success or failure.  A null result indicates
        out-of-memory or inability to send the command at all.  Use
        <function>PQerrorMessage</function> to get more information about
        such errors.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
    </variablelist>

    Prepared statements for use with <function>PQexecPrepared</> can also
1965
    be created by executing SQL <xref linkend="sql-prepare">
1966
    statements.  Also, although there is no <application>libpq</>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1967
    function for deleting a prepared statement, the SQL <xref
1968
    linkend="sql-deallocate"> statement
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1969 1970 1971 1972 1973
    can be used for that purpose.
   </para>

   <para>
    <variablelist>
1974
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqexecprepared">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1975 1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985
      <term>
       <function>PQexecPrepared</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQexecPrepared</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Sends a request to execute a prepared statement with given
        parameters, and waits for the result.
1986 1987 1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQexecPrepared(PGconn *conn,
                         const char *stmtName,
                         int nParams,
                         const char * const *paramValues,
                         const int *paramLengths,
                         const int *paramFormats,
                         int resultFormat);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017
       </para>

       <para>
        <function>PQexecPrepared</> is like <function>PQexecParams</>,
        but the command to be executed is specified by naming a
        previously-prepared statement, instead of giving a query string.
        This feature allows commands that will be used repeatedly to be
        parsed and planned just once, rather than each time they are
        executed.  The statement must have been prepared previously in
        the current session.  <function>PQexecPrepared</> is supported
        only in protocol 3.0 and later connections; it will fail when
        using protocol 2.0.
       </para>

       <para>
        The parameters are identical to <function>PQexecParams</>, except that the
        name of a prepared statement is given instead of a query string, and the
        <parameter>paramTypes[]</> parameter is not present (it is not needed since
        the prepared statement's parameter types were determined when it was created).
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>

2018
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqdescribeprepared">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029
      <term>
       <function>PQdescribePrepared</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQdescribePrepared</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Submits a request to obtain information about the specified
        prepared statement, and waits for completion.
2030 2031 2032
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQdescribePrepared(PGconn *conn, const char *stmtName);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042
       </para>

       <para>
        <function>PQdescribePrepared</> allows an application to obtain
        information about a previously prepared statement.
        <function>PQdescribePrepared</> is supported only in protocol 3.0
        and later connections; it will fail when using protocol 2.0.
       </para>

       <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
2043
        <parameter>stmtName</> can be <literal>""</> or <symbol>NULL</> to reference
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057
        the unnamed statement, otherwise it must be the name of an existing
        prepared statement.  On success, a <structname>PGresult</> with
        status <literal>PGRES_COMMAND_OK</literal> is returned.  The
        functions <function>PQnparams</function> and
        <function>PQparamtype</function> can be applied to this
        <structname>PGresult</> to obtain information about the parameters
        of the prepared statement, and the functions
        <function>PQnfields</function>, <function>PQfname</function>,
        <function>PQftype</function>, etc provide information about the
        result columns (if any) of the statement.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>

2058
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqdescribeportal">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2059 2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069
      <term>
       <function>PQdescribePortal</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQdescribePortal</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Submits a request to obtain information about the specified
        portal, and waits for completion.
2070 2071 2072
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQdescribePortal(PGconn *conn, const char *portalName);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2073
       </para>
2074

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085
       <para>
        <function>PQdescribePortal</> allows an application to obtain
        information about a previously created portal.
        (<application>libpq</> does not provide any direct access to
        portals, but you can use this function to inspect the properties
        of a cursor created with a <command>DECLARE CURSOR</> SQL command.)
        <function>PQdescribePortal</> is supported only in protocol 3.0
        and later connections; it will fail when using protocol 2.0.
       </para>

       <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
2086
        <parameter>portalName</> can be <literal>""</> or <symbol>NULL</> to reference
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2087 2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2098 2099 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 2110
        the unnamed portal, otherwise it must be the name of an existing
        portal.  On success, a <structname>PGresult</> with status
        <literal>PGRES_COMMAND_OK</literal> is returned.  The functions
        <function>PQnfields</function>, <function>PQfname</function>,
        <function>PQftype</function>, etc can be applied to the
        <structname>PGresult</> to obtain information about the result
        columns (if any) of the portal.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
    </variablelist>
   </para>

   <para>
    The <structname>PGresult</structname><indexterm><primary>PGresult</></>
    structure encapsulates the result returned by the server.
    <application>libpq</application> application programmers should be
    careful to maintain the <structname>PGresult</structname> abstraction.
    Use the accessor functions below to get at the contents of
    <structname>PGresult</structname>.  Avoid directly referencing the
    fields of the <structname>PGresult</structname> structure because they
    are subject to change in the future.

    <variablelist>
2111
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresultstatus">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2112 2113 2114 2115 2116 2117 2118 2119 2120 2121
      <term>
       <function>PQresultStatus</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQresultStatus</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Returns the result status of the command.
2122 2123 2124
<synopsis>
ExecStatusType PQresultStatus(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130
       </para>

       <para>
        <function>PQresultStatus</function> can return one of the following values:

        <variablelist>
2131
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-empty-query">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139
          <term><literal>PGRES_EMPTY_QUERY</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The string sent to the server was empty.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2140
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-command-ok">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148
          <term><literal>PGRES_COMMAND_OK</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Successful completion of a command returning no data.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2149
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-tuples-ok">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158
          <term><literal>PGRES_TUPLES_OK</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Successful completion of a command returning data (such as
            a <command>SELECT</> or <command>SHOW</>).
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2159
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-copy-out">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167
          <term><literal>PGRES_COPY_OUT</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Copy Out (from server) data transfer started.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2168
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-copy-in">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176
          <term><literal>PGRES_COPY_IN</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Copy In (to server) data transfer started.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2177
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-bad-response">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183 2184 2185
          <term><literal>PGRES_BAD_RESPONSE</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The server's response was not understood.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2186
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-nonfatal-error">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194
          <term><literal>PGRES_NONFATAL_ERROR</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            A nonfatal error (a notice or warning) occurred.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2195
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pgres-fatal-error">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2196 2197 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218 2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225
          <term><literal>PGRES_FATAL_ERROR</literal></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            A fatal error occurred.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
        </variablelist>

        If the result status is <literal>PGRES_TUPLES_OK</literal>, then
        the functions described below can be used to retrieve the rows
        returned by the query.  Note that a <command>SELECT</command>
        command that happens to retrieve zero rows still shows
        <literal>PGRES_TUPLES_OK</literal>.
        <literal>PGRES_COMMAND_OK</literal> is for commands that can never
        return rows (<command>INSERT</command>, <command>UPDATE</command>,
        etc.). A response of <literal>PGRES_EMPTY_QUERY</literal> might
        indicate a bug in the client software.
       </para>

       <para>
        A result of status <symbol>PGRES_NONFATAL_ERROR</symbol> will
        never be returned directly by <function>PQexec</function> or other
        query execution functions; results of this kind are instead passed
        to the notice processor (see <xref
        linkend="libpq-notice-processing">).
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>

2226
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresstatus">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2227 2228 2229 2230 2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239
      <term>
       <function>PQresStatus</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQresStatus</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Converts the enumerated type returned by
        <function>PQresultStatus</> into a string constant describing the
        status code. The caller should not free the result.

2240 2241 2242
<synopsis>
char *PQresStatus(ExecStatusType status);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2243 2244 2245 2246
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>

2247
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresulterrormessage">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258
      <term>
       <function>PQresultErrorMessage</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQresultErrorMessage</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
        Returns the error message associated with the command, or an empty string
        if there was no error.
2259 2260 2261
<synopsis>
char *PQresultErrorMessage(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284
        If there was an error, the returned string will include a trailing
        newline.  The caller should not free the result directly. It will
        be freed when the associated <structname>PGresult</> handle is
        passed to <function>PQclear</function>.
       </para>

       <para>
        Immediately following a <function>PQexec</function> or
        <function>PQgetResult</function> call,
        <function>PQerrorMessage</function> (on the connection) will return
        the same string as <function>PQresultErrorMessage</function> (on
        the result).  However, a <structname>PGresult</structname> will
        retain its error message until destroyed, whereas the connection's
        error message will change when subsequent operations are done.
        Use <function>PQresultErrorMessage</function> when you want to
        know the status associated with a particular
        <structname>PGresult</structname>; use
        <function>PQerrorMessage</function> when you want to know the
        status from the latest operation on the connection.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>

2285
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresulterrorfield">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2286 2287 2288 2289
      <term><function>PQresultErrorField</function><indexterm><primary>PQresultErrorField</></></term>
      <listitem>
       <para>
        Returns an individual field of an error report.
2290 2291 2292
<synopsis>
char *PQresultErrorField(const PGresult *res, int fieldcode);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305
        <parameter>fieldcode</> is an error field identifier; see the symbols
        listed below.  <symbol>NULL</symbol> is returned if the
        <structname>PGresult</structname> is not an error or warning result,
        or does not include the specified field.  Field values will normally
        not include a trailing newline. The caller should not free the
        result directly. It will be freed when the
        associated <structname>PGresult</> handle is passed to
        <function>PQclear</function>.
       </para>

       <para>
        The following field codes are available:
        <variablelist>
2306
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-severity">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2307 2308 2309 2310 2311 2312 2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_SEVERITY</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The severity; the field contents are <literal>ERROR</>,
            <literal>FATAL</>, or <literal>PANIC</> (in an error message),
            or <literal>WARNING</>, <literal>NOTICE</>, <literal>DEBUG</>,
            <literal>INFO</>, or <literal>LOG</> (in a notice message), or
            a localized translation of one of these.  Always present.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2319
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-sqlstate">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2320 2321 2322 2323 2324 2325 2326 2327 2328 2329 2330 2331 2332 2333 2334 2335 2336 2337
          <indexterm>
           <primary>error codes</primary>
           <secondary>libpq</secondary>
          </indexterm>
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_SQLSTATE</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The SQLSTATE code for the error. The SQLSTATE code identifies
            the type of error that has occurred; it can be used by
            front-end applications to perform specific operations (such
            as error handling) in response to a particular database error.
            For a list of the possible SQLSTATE codes, see <xref
            linkend="errcodes-appendix">. This field is not localizable,
            and is always present.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2338
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-message-primary">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344 2345 2346 2347
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_MESSAGE_PRIMARY</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The primary human-readable error message (typically one line).
            Always present.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2348
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-message-detail">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_MESSAGE_DETAIL</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Detail: an optional secondary error message carrying more
            detail about the problem.  Might run to multiple lines.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2358
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-message-hint">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_MESSAGE_HINT</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            Hint: an optional suggestion what to do about the problem.
            This is intended to differ from detail in that it offers advice
            (potentially inappropriate) rather than hard facts.  Might
            run to multiple lines.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>

2370
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-statement-position">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2371 2372
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_STATEMENT_POSITION</></term>
          <listitem>
2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380
           <para>
            A string containing a decimal integer indicating an error cursor
            position as an index into the original statement string.  The
            first character has index 1, and positions are measured in
            characters not bytes.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2381

2382
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-internal-position">
2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_INTERNAL_POSITION</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            This is defined the same as the
            <symbol>PG_DIAG_STATEMENT_POSITION</> field, but it is used
            when the cursor position refers to an internally generated
            command rather than the one submitted by the client.  The
            <symbol>PG_DIAG_INTERNAL_QUERY</> field will always appear when
            this field appears.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2395

2396
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-internal-query">
2397 2398 2399 2400 2401 2402 2403 2404
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_INTERNAL_QUERY</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The text of a failed internally-generated command.  This could
            be, for example, a SQL query issued by a PL/pgSQL function.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2405

2406
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-context">
2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415 2416
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_CONTEXT</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            An indication of the context in which the error occurred.
            Presently this includes a call stack traceback of active
            procedural language functions and internally-generated queries.
            The trace is one entry per line, most recent first.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2417

2418
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-source-file">
2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424 2425 2426
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_SOURCE_FILE</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The file name of the source-code location where the error was
            reported.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2427

2428
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-source-line">
2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434 2435 2436
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_SOURCE_LINE</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The line number of the source-code location where the error
            was reported.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2437

2438
         <varlistentry id="libpq-pg-diag-source-function">
2439 2440 2441 2442 2443 2444 2445 2446 2447
          <term><symbol>PG_DIAG_SOURCE_FUNCTION</></term>
          <listitem>
           <para>
            The name of the source-code function reporting the error.
           </para>
          </listitem>
         </varlistentry>
        </variablelist>
       </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2448

2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454
       <para>
        The client is responsible for formatting displayed information to meet
        its needs; in particular it should break long lines as needed.
        Newline characters appearing in the error message fields should be
        treated as paragraph breaks, not line breaks.
       </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2455

2456 2457 2458 2459 2460 2461
       <para>
        Errors generated internally by <application>libpq</application> will
        have severity and primary message, but typically no other fields.
        Errors returned by a pre-3.0-protocol server will include severity and
        primary message, and sometimes a detail message, but no other fields.
       </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2462

2463 2464 2465 2466 2467 2468 2469 2470
       <para>
        Note that error fields are only available from
        <structname>PGresult</structname> objects, not
        <structname>PGconn</structname> objects; there is no
        <function>PQerrorField</function> function.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2471

2472
     <varlistentry id="libpq-pqclear">
2473 2474 2475 2476 2477 2478 2479 2480
      <term><function>PQclear</function><indexterm><primary>PQclear</></></term>
      <listitem>
       <para>
        Frees  the  storage  associated with a
        <structname>PGresult</structname>.  Every command result should be
        freed via <function>PQclear</function> when it  is  no  longer
        needed.

2481 2482 2483
<synopsis>
void PQclear(PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
2484
       </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2485

2486 2487 2488 2489 2490 2491 2492 2493 2494 2495 2496 2497
       <para>
        You can keep a <structname>PGresult</structname> object around for
        as long as you need it; it does not go away when you issue a new
        command, nor even if you close the connection.  To get rid of it,
        you must call <function>PQclear</function>.  Failure to do this
        will result in memory leaks in your application.
       </para>
      </listitem>
     </varlistentry>
    </variablelist>
   </para>
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2498

2499 2500
  <sect2 id="libpq-exec-select-info">
   <title>Retrieving Query Result Information</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2501

2502 2503 2504 2505 2506 2507 2508 2509 2510 2511
   <para>
    These functions are used to extract information from a
    <structname>PGresult</structname> object that represents a successful
    query result (that is, one that has status
    <literal>PGRES_TUPLES_OK</literal>).  They can also be used to extract
    information from a successful Describe operation: a Describe's result
    has all the same column information that actual execution of the query
    would provide, but it has zero rows.  For objects with other status values,
    these functions will act as though the result has zero rows and zero columns.
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2512

2513
   <variablelist>
2514
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqntuples">
2515 2516 2517 2518 2519 2520
     <term>
      <function>PQntuples</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQntuples</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2521

2522 2523
     <listitem>
      <para>
2524 2525 2526
       Returns the number of rows (tuples) in the query result.  Because
       it returns an integer result, large result sets might overflow the
       return value on 32-bit operating systems.
2527

2528 2529 2530
<synopsis>
int PQntuples(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
2531

2532 2533 2534
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2535

2536
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqnfields">
2537 2538 2539 2540 2541 2542
     <term>
      <function>PQnfields</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQnfields</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2543

2544 2545 2546 2547
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the number of columns (fields) in each row of the query
       result.
2548

2549 2550 2551
<synopsis>
int PQnfields(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
2552 2553 2554
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2555

2556
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfname">
2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562
     <term>
      <function>PQfname</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfname</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
2563

2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the column name associated with the given column number.
       Column numbers start at 0. The caller should not free the result
       directly. It will be freed when the associated
       <structname>PGresult</> handle is passed to
       <function>PQclear</function>.
2571 2572 2573 2574
<synopsis>
char *PQfname(const PGresult *res,
              int column_number);
</synopsis>
2575
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2576

2577 2578 2579 2580 2581
      <para>
       <symbol>NULL</symbol> is returned if the column number is out of range.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2582

2583
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfnumber">
2584 2585 2586 2587 2588 2589
     <term>
      <function>PQfnumber</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfnumber</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2590

2591 2592 2593
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the column number associated with the given column name.
2594 2595 2596 2597
<synopsis>
int PQfnumber(const PGresult *res,
              const char *column_name);
</synopsis>
2598
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2599

2600 2601 2602
      <para>
       -1 is returned if the given name does not match any column.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2603

2604 2605 2606 2607
      <para>
       The given name is treated like an identifier in an SQL command,
       that is, it is downcased unless double-quoted.  For example, given
       a query result generated from the SQL command:
2608
<programlisting>
2609
SELECT 1 AS FOO, 2 AS "BAR";
2610
</programlisting>
2611
       we would have the results:
2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617 2618 2619
<programlisting>
PQfname(res, 0)              <lineannotation>foo</lineannotation>
PQfname(res, 1)              <lineannotation>BAR</lineannotation>
PQfnumber(res, "FOO")        <lineannotation>0</lineannotation>
PQfnumber(res, "foo")        <lineannotation>0</lineannotation>
PQfnumber(res, "BAR")        <lineannotation>-1</lineannotation>
PQfnumber(res, "\"BAR\"")    <lineannotation>1</lineannotation>
</programlisting>
2620 2621 2622
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2623

2624
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqftable">
2625 2626 2627 2628 2629 2630
     <term>
      <function>PQftable</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQftable</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2631

2632 2633 2634 2635
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the OID of the table from which the given column was
       fetched.  Column numbers start at 0.
2636 2637 2638 2639
<synopsis>
Oid PQftable(const PGresult *res,
             int column_number);
</synopsis>
2640
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2641

2642 2643 2644 2645 2646 2647 2648
      <para>
       <literal>InvalidOid</> is returned if the column number is out of range,
       or if the specified column is not a simple reference to a table column,
       or when using pre-3.0 protocol.
       You can query the system table <literal>pg_class</literal> to determine
       exactly which table is referenced.
      </para>
T
Tom Lane 已提交
2649

2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657
      <para>
       The type <type>Oid</type> and the constant
       <literal>InvalidOid</literal> will be defined when you include
       the <application>libpq</application> header file. They will both
       be some integer type.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2658

2659
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqftablecol">
2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665
     <term>
      <function>PQftablecol</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQftablecol</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2666

2667 2668 2669 2670 2671
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the column number (within its table) of the column making
       up the specified query result column.  Query-result column numbers
       start at 0, but table columns have nonzero numbers.
2672 2673 2674 2675
<synopsis>
int PQftablecol(const PGresult *res,
                int column_number);
</synopsis>
2676
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2677

2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684
      <para>
       Zero is returned if the column number is out of range, or if the
       specified column is not a simple reference to a table column, or
       when using pre-3.0 protocol.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
2685

2686
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfformat">
2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692
     <term>
      <function>PQfformat</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfformat</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2693

2694 2695 2696 2697
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the format code indicating the format of the given
       column.  Column numbers start at 0.
2698 2699 2700 2701
<synopsis>
int PQfformat(const PGresult *res,
              int column_number);
</synopsis>
2702
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2703

2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710
      <para>
       Format code zero indicates textual data representation, while format
       code one indicates binary representation.  (Other codes are reserved
       for future definition.)
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2711

2712
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqftype">
2713 2714 2715 2716 2717 2718
     <term>
      <function>PQftype</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQftype</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
2719

2720 2721 2722 2723 2724
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the data type associated with the given  column number.
       The  integer  returned is the internal OID number of the type.
       Column numbers start at 0.
2725 2726 2727 2728
<synopsis>
Oid PQftype(const PGresult *res,
            int column_number);
</synopsis>
2729
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2730

2731 2732 2733 2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739
      <para>
       You can query the system table <literal>pg_type</literal> to
       obtain the names and properties of the various data types. The
       <acronym>OID</acronym>s of the built-in data types are defined
       in the file <filename>src/include/catalog/pg_type.h</filename>
       in the source tree.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2740

2741
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfmod">
2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752
     <term>
      <function>PQfmod</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfmod</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns  the type modifier of the column associated with the
       given column number.  Column numbers start at 0.
2753 2754 2755 2756
<synopsis>
int PQfmod(const PGresult *res,
           int column_number);
</synopsis>
2757
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2758

2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767
      <para>
       The interpretation of modifier values is type-specific; they
       typically indicate precision or size limits.  The value -1 is
       used to indicate <quote>no information available</>.  Most data
       types do not use modifiers, in which case the value is always
       -1.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2768

2769
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfsize">
2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780
     <term>
      <function>PQfsize</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfsize</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns  the  size  in bytes of the column associated with the
       given column number.  Column numbers start at 0.
2781 2782 2783 2784
<synopsis>
int PQfsize(const PGresult *res,
            int column_number);
</synopsis>
2785
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2786

2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795
      <para>
       <function>PQfsize</> returns the space allocated for this column
       in a database row, in other words the size of the server's
       internal representation of the data type.  (Accordingly, it is
       not really very useful to clients.) A negative value indicates
       the data type is variable-length.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2796

2797
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqbinarytuples">
2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805
     <term>
      <function>PQbinaryTuples</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQbinaryTuples</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2806 2807 2808
      <para>
       Returns 1 if the <structname>PGresult</> contains binary data
       and 0 if it contains text data.
2809 2810 2811
<synopsis>
int PQbinaryTuples(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2812
      </para>
2813

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821 2822 2823
      <para>
       This function is deprecated (except for its use in connection with
       <command>COPY</>), because it is possible for a single
       <structname>PGresult</> to contain text data in some columns and
       binary data in others.  <function>PQfformat</> is preferred.
       <function>PQbinaryTuples</> returns 1 only if all columns of the
       result are binary (format 1).
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2824

2825
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetvalue">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831
     <term>
      <function>PQgetvalue</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQgetvalue</primary>
       </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2832

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns a single field value of one row of a
       <structname>PGresult</structname>.  Row and column numbers start
       at 0.  The caller should not free the result directly.  It will
       be freed when the associated <structname>PGresult</> handle is
       passed to <function>PQclear</function>.
2840 2841 2842 2843 2844
<synopsis>
char *PQgetvalue(const PGresult *res,
                 int row_number,
                 int column_number);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2845
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2846

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856
      <para>
       For data in text format, the value returned by
       <function>PQgetvalue</function> is a null-terminated character
       string  representation of the field value.  For data in binary
       format, the value is in the binary representation determined by
       the data type's <function>typsend</> and <function>typreceive</>
       functions.  (The value is actually followed by a zero byte in
       this case too, but that is not ordinarily useful, since the
       value is likely to contain embedded nulls.)
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2857

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2858 2859 2860 2861 2862
      <para>
       An empty string is returned if the field value is null.  See
       <function>PQgetisnull</> to distinguish null values from
       empty-string values.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2863

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870 2871 2872 2873
      <para>
       The pointer returned  by  <function>PQgetvalue</function> points
       to storage that is part of the <structname>PGresult</structname>
       structure.  One should not modify the data it points to, and one
       must explicitly copy the data into other storage if it is to be
       used past the lifetime of the  <structname>PGresult</structname>
       structure itself.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2874

2875
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetisnull">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885
     <term>
      <function>PQgetisnull</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetisnull</primary>
      </indexterm>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>null value</primary>
       <secondary sortas="libpq">in libpq</secondary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2886

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2887 2888 2889 2890
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Tests a field for a null value.  Row and column numbers start
       at 0.
2891 2892 2893 2894 2895
<synopsis>
int PQgetisnull(const PGresult *res,
                int row_number,
                int column_number);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2896
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2897

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905
      <para>
       This function returns  1 if the field is null and 0 if it
       contains a non-null value.  (Note that
       <function>PQgetvalue</function> will return an empty string,
       not a null pointer, for a null field.)
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2906

2907
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetlength">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2908 2909 2910 2911 2912
     <term>
     <function>PQgetlength</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQgetlength</primary>
     </indexterm></term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2913

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2914 2915 2916 2917
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the actual length of a field value in bytes.  Row and
       column numbers start at 0.
2918 2919 2920 2921 2922
<synopsis>
int PQgetlength(const PGresult *res,
                int row_number,
                int column_number);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2923
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2924

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935
      <para>
       This is the actual data length for the particular data value,
       that is, the size of the object pointed to by
       <function>PQgetvalue</function>.  For text data format this is
       the same as <function>strlen()</>.  For binary format this is
       essential information.  Note that one should <emphasis>not</>
       rely on <function>PQfsize</function> to obtain the actual data
       length.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2936

2937
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqnparams">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943
     <term>
      <function>PQnparams</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQnparams</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2944

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2945 2946 2947
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the number of parameters of a prepared statement.
2948 2949 2950
<synopsis>
int PQnparams(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2951
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2952

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2953 2954 2955 2956 2957 2958 2959
      <para>
       This function is only useful when inspecting the result of
       <function>PQdescribePrepared</>.  For other types of queries it
       will return zero.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2960

2961
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqparamtype">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2962 2963 2964 2965 2966 2967
     <term>
      <function>PQparamtype</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQparamtype</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2968

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2969 2970 2971 2972
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the data type of the indicated statement parameter.
       Parameter numbers start at 0.
2973 2974 2975
<synopsis>
Oid PQparamtype(const PGresult *res, int param_number);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2976
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2977

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984
      <para>
       This function is only useful when inspecting the result of
       <function>PQdescribePrepared</>.  For other types of queries it
       will return zero.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2985

2986
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqprint">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992
     <term>
      <function>PQprint</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQprint</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2993

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
2994 2995 2996 2997
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Prints out all the rows and,  optionally,  the column names  to
       the specified output stream.
2998
<synopsis>
2999 3000 3001
void PQprint(FILE *fout,      /* output stream */
             const PGresult *res,
             const PQprintOpt *po);
3002 3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010 3011 3012 3013
typedef struct
{
    pqbool  header;      /* print output field headings and row count */
    pqbool  align;       /* fill align the fields */
    pqbool  standard;    /* old brain dead format */
    pqbool  html3;       /* output HTML tables */
    pqbool  expanded;    /* expand tables */
    pqbool  pager;       /* use pager for output if needed */
    char    *fieldSep;   /* field separator */
    char    *tableOpt;   /* attributes for HTML table element */
    char    *caption;    /* HTML table caption */
    char    **fieldName; /* null-terminated array of replacement field names */
3014
} PQprintOpt;
3015
</synopsis>
3016
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3017

3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026
      <para>
       This function was formerly used by <application>psql</application>
       to print query results, but this is no longer the case.  Note
       that it assumes all the data is in text format.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3027

3028
  <sect2 id="libpq-exec-nonselect">
3029
   <title>Retrieving Other Result Information</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3030

3031
   <para>
3032 3033
    These functions are used to extract other information from
    <structname>PGresult</structname> objects.
3034
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3035

3036
   <variablelist>
3037
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqcmdstatus">
3038 3039 3040 3041 3042 3043 3044 3045 3046 3047 3048
     <term>
      <function>PQcmdStatus</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQcmdStatus</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the command status tag from the SQL command that generated
       the <structname>PGresult</structname>.
3049 3050 3051
<synopsis>
char *PQcmdStatus(PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
3052 3053 3054 3055 3056 3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062
      </para>

      <para>
       Commonly this is just the name of the command, but it might include
       additional data such as the number of rows processed. The caller
       should not free the result directly. It will be freed when the
       associated <structname>PGresult</> handle is passed to
       <function>PQclear</function>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3063

3064
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqcmdtuples">
3065 3066 3067 3068 3069 3070 3071 3072 3073 3074
     <term>
      <function>PQcmdTuples</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQcmdTuples</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the number of rows affected by the SQL command.
3075 3076 3077
<synopsis>
char *PQcmdTuples(PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
3078
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3079

3080 3081 3082 3083
      <para>
       This function returns a string containing the number of rows
       affected by the <acronym>SQL</> statement that generated the
       <structname>PGresult</>. This function can only be used following
3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089
       the execution of a <command>SELECT</>, <command>CREATE TABLE AS</>,
       <command>INSERT</>, <command>UPDATE</>, <command>DELETE</>,
       <command>MOVE</>, <command>FETCH</>, or <command>COPY</> statement,
       or an <command>EXECUTE</> of a prepared query that contains an
       <command>INSERT</>, <command>UPDATE</>, or <command>DELETE</> statement.
       If the command that generated the <structname>PGresult</> was anything
3090 3091 3092 3093 3094 3095 3096
       else, <function>PQcmdTuples</> returns an empty string. The caller
       should not free the return value directly. It will be freed when
       the associated <structname>PGresult</> handle is passed to
       <function>PQclear</function>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3097

3098
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqoidvalue">
3099 3100 3101 3102 3103 3104 3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115
     <term>
      <function>PQoidValue</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQoidValue</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the OID<indexterm><primary>OID</><secondary>in libpq</></>
       of the inserted row, if the <acronym>SQL</> command was an
       <command>INSERT</> that inserted exactly one row into a table that
       has OIDs, or a <command>EXECUTE</> of a prepared query containing
       a suitable <command>INSERT</> statement.  Otherwise, this function
       returns <literal>InvalidOid</literal>. This function will also
       return <literal>InvalidOid</literal> if the table affected by the
       <command>INSERT</> statement does not contain OIDs.
3116 3117 3118
<synopsis>
Oid PQoidValue(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
3119 3120 3121
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3122

3123
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqoidstatus">
3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131 3132 3133 3134 3135 3136 3137 3138 3139 3140
     <term>
      <function>PQoidStatus</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQoidStatus</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns a string with the OID of the inserted row, if the
       <acronym>SQL</acronym> command was an <command>INSERT</command>
       that inserted exactly one row, or a <command>EXECUTE</command> of
       a prepared statement consisting of a suitable
       <command>INSERT</command>.  (The string will be <literal>0</> if
       the <command>INSERT</command> did not insert exactly one row, or
       if the target table does not have OIDs.)  If the command was not
       an <command>INSERT</command>, returns an empty string.
3141 3142 3143
<synopsis>
char *PQoidStatus(const PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
3144
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3145

3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152
      <para>
       This function is deprecated in favor of
       <function>PQoidValue</function>.  It is not thread-safe.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3153

3154
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3155

3156 3157
  <sect2 id="libpq-exec-escape-string">
   <title>Escaping Strings for Inclusion in SQL Commands</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3158

3159 3160 3161 3162
   <indexterm zone="libpq-exec-escape-string">
    <primary>escaping strings</primary>
    <secondary>in libpq</secondary>
   </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3163

3164
   <variablelist>
3165
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapeliteral">
3166
     <term>
3167
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</function>
3168
      <indexterm>
3169
       <primary>PQescapeLiteral</primary>
3170 3171
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3172

3173 3174
     <listitem>
     <para>
3175
<synopsis>
3176
char *PQescapeLiteral(PGconn *conn, const char *str, size_t length);
3177
</synopsis>
3178 3179 3180 3181
     </para>

     <para>
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</function> escapes a string for
3182 3183 3184 3185
      use within an SQL command.  This is useful when inserting data
      values as literal constants in SQL commands.  Certain characters
      (such as quotes and backslashes) must be escaped to prevent them
      from being interpreted specially by the SQL parser.
3186 3187 3188 3189 3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195 3196 3197 3198 3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</> performs this operation.
     </para>

     <para>
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</> returns an escaped version of the
      <parameter>str</parameter> parameter in memory allocated with
      <function>malloc()</>.  This memory should be freed using
      <function>PQfreemem()</> when the result is no longer needed.
      A terminating zero byte is not required, and should not be
      counted in <parameter>length</>.  (If a terminating zero byte is found
      before <parameter>length</> bytes are processed,
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</> stops at the zero; the behavior is
      thus rather like <function>strncpy</>.) The
      return string has all special characters replaced so that they can
      be properly processed by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>
      string literal parser.  A terminating zero byte is also added.  The
      single quotes that must surround <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>
      string literals are included in the result string.
     </para>

     <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3207
      On error, <function>PQescapeLiteral</> returns <symbol>NULL</> and a suitable
3208
      message is stored in the <parameter>conn</> object.
3209
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3210

3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219
     <tip>
      <para>
       It is especially important to do proper escaping when handling
       strings that were received from an untrustworthy source.
       Otherwise there is a security risk: you are vulnerable to
       <quote>SQL injection</> attacks wherein unwanted SQL commands are
       fed to your database.
      </para>
     </tip>
3220

3221 3222 3223 3224
     <para>
      Note that it is not necessary nor correct to do escaping when a data
      value is passed as a separate parameter in <function>PQexecParams</> or
      its sibling routines.
3225 3226 3227 3228
     </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

3229
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapeidentifier">
3230 3231 3232 3233 3234 3235 3236 3237 3238
     <term>
      <function>PQescapeIdentifier</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQescapeIdentifier</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
     <para>
3239
<synopsis>
3240
char *PQescapeIdentifier(PGconn *conn, const char *str, size_t length);
3241
</synopsis>
3242 3243 3244
     </para>

     <para>
3245
      <function>PQescapeIdentifier</function> escapes a string for
3246 3247 3248 3249
      use as an SQL identifier, such as a table, column, or function name.
      This is useful when a user-supplied identifier might contain
      special characters that would otherwise not be interpreted as part
      of the identifier by the SQL parser, or when the identifier might
3250
      contain upper case characters whose case should be preserved.
3251
     </para>
3252

3253 3254 3255 3256 3257 3258 3259 3260 3261 3262 3263 3264 3265 3266 3267 3268 3269
     <para>
      <function>PQescapeIdentifier</> returns a version of the
      <parameter>str</parameter> parameter escaped as an SQL identifier
      in memory allocated with <function>malloc()</>.  This memory must be
      freed using <function>PQfreemem()</> when the result is no longer
      needed.  A terminating zero byte is not required, and should not be
      counted in <parameter>length</>.  (If a terminating zero byte is found
      before <parameter>length</> bytes are processed,
      <function>PQescapeIdentifier</> stops at the zero; the behavior is
      thus rather like <function>strncpy</>.) The
      return string has all special characters replaced so that it
      will be properly processed as an SQL identifier.  A terminating zero byte
      is also added.  The return string will also be surrounded by double
      quotes.
     </para>

     <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3270
      On error, <function>PQescapeIdentifier</> returns <symbol>NULL</> and a suitable
3271 3272 3273 3274 3275 3276 3277 3278 3279 3280 3281 3282 3283
      message is stored in the <parameter>conn</> object.
     </para>

     <tip>
      <para>
       As with string literals, to prevent SQL injection attacks,
       SQL identifiers must be escaped when they are received from an
       untrustworthy source.
      </para>
     </tip>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

3284
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapestringconn">
3285 3286 3287 3288 3289 3290 3291 3292 3293
     <term>
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQescapeStringConn</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
     <para>
3294 3295 3296 3297 3298
<synopsis>
size_t PQescapeStringConn(PGconn *conn,
                          char *to, const char *from, size_t length,
                          int *error);
</synopsis>
3299
     </para>
3300

3301
     <para>
3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</> escapes string literals, much like
      <function>PQescapeLiteral</>.  Unlike <function>PQescapeLiteral</>,
      the caller is responsible for providing an appropriately sized buffer.
      Furthermore, <function>PQescapeStringConn</> does not generate the
      single quotes that must surround <productname>PostgreSQL</> string
      literals; they should be provided in the SQL command that the
3308 3309 3310 3311 3312 3313 3314 3315 3316 3317 3318 3319 3320
      result is inserted into.  The parameter <parameter>from</> points to
      the first character of the string that is to be escaped, and the
      <parameter>length</> parameter gives the number of bytes in this
      string.  A terminating zero byte is not required, and should not be
      counted in <parameter>length</>.  (If a terminating zero byte is found
      before <parameter>length</> bytes are processed,
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</> stops at the zero; the behavior is
      thus rather like <function>strncpy</>.) <parameter>to</> shall point
      to a buffer that is able to hold at least one more byte than twice
      the value of <parameter>length</>, otherwise the behavior is undefined.
      Behavior is likewise undefined if the <parameter>to</> and
      <parameter>from</> strings overlap.
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3321

3322
     <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3323
      If the <parameter>error</> parameter is not <symbol>NULL</>, then
3324 3325 3326 3327 3328
      <literal>*error</> is set to zero on success, nonzero on error.
      Presently the only possible error conditions involve invalid multibyte
      encoding in the source string.  The output string is still generated
      on error, but it can be expected that the server will reject it as
      malformed.  On error, a suitable message is stored in the
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3329
      <parameter>conn</> object, whether or not <parameter>error</> is <symbol>NULL</>.
3330
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3331

3332 3333 3334 3335 3336 3337
     <para>
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</> returns the number of bytes written
      to <parameter>to</>, not including the terminating zero byte.
     </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
3338

3339
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapestring">
3340 3341 3342 3343 3344 3345
     <term>
      <function>PQescapeString</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQescapeString</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3346

3347 3348
     <listitem>
     <para>
3349 3350 3351
<synopsis>
size_t PQescapeString (char *to, const char *from, size_t length);
</synopsis>
3352
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3353

3354 3355 3356 3357 3358 3359 3360 3361 3362
     <para>
      <function>PQescapeString</> is an older, deprecated version of
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</>; the difference is that it does
      not take <parameter>conn</> or <parameter>error</> parameters.
      Because of this, it cannot adjust its behavior depending on the
      connection properties (such as character encoding) and therefore
      <emphasis>it might give the wrong results</>.  Also, it has no way
      to report error conditions.
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3363

3364 3365 3366 3367 3368 3369 3370 3371 3372 3373
     <para>
      <function>PQescapeString</> can be used safely in single-threaded
      client programs that work with only one <productname>PostgreSQL</>
      connection at a time (in this case it can find out what it needs to
      know <quote>behind the scenes</>).  In other contexts it is a security
      hazard and should be avoided in favor of
      <function>PQescapeStringConn</>.
     </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3374

3375
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapebyteaconn">
3376 3377 3378 3379 3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387
     <term>
      <function>PQescapeByteaConn</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQescapeByteaConn</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
     <para>
       Escapes binary data for use within an SQL command with the type
       <type>bytea</type>.  As with <function>PQescapeStringConn</function>,
       this is only used when inserting data directly into an SQL command string.
3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393
<synopsis>
unsigned char *PQescapeByteaConn(PGconn *conn,
                                 const unsigned char *from,
                                 size_t from_length,
                                 size_t *to_length);
</synopsis>
3394
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3395

3396 3397 3398 3399 3400 3401 3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407
      <para>
       Certain byte values <emphasis>must</emphasis> be escaped (but all
       byte values <emphasis>can</emphasis> be escaped) when used as part
       of a <type>bytea</type> literal in an <acronym>SQL</acronym>
       statement. In general, to escape a byte, it is converted into the
       three digit octal number equal to the octet value, and preceded by
       usually two backslashes. The single quote (<literal>'</>) and backslash
       (<literal>\</>) characters have special alternative escape
       sequences. See <xref linkend="datatype-binary"> for more
       information. <function>PQescapeByteaConn</function> performs this
       operation, escaping only the minimally required bytes.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3408

3409 3410 3411 3412 3413 3414 3415 3416 3417 3418
      <para>
       The <parameter>from</parameter> parameter points to the first
       byte of the string that is to be escaped, and the
       <parameter>from_length</parameter> parameter gives the number of
       bytes in this binary string.  (A terminating zero byte is
       neither necessary nor counted.)  The <parameter>to_length</parameter>
       parameter points to a variable that will hold the resultant
       escaped string length. This result string length includes the terminating
       zero byte of the result.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3419

3420 3421 3422
      <para>
       <function>PQescapeByteaConn</> returns an escaped version of the
       <parameter>from</parameter> parameter binary string in memory
3423
       allocated with <function>malloc()</>.  This memory should be freed using
3424 3425 3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431
       <function>PQfreemem()</> when the result is no longer needed.  The
       return string has all special characters replaced so that they can
       be properly processed by the <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>
       string literal parser, and the <type>bytea</type> input function. A
       terminating zero byte is also added.  The single quotes that must
       surround <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> string literals are
       not part of the result string.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3432

3433
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3434
       On error, a null pointer is returned, and a suitable error message
3435 3436 3437 3438 3439
       is stored in the <parameter>conn</> object.  Currently, the only
       possible error is insufficient memory for the result string.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3440

3441
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqescapebytea">
3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448 3449 3450 3451 3452
     <term>
      <function>PQescapeBytea</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQescapeBytea</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       <function>PQescapeBytea</> is an older, deprecated version of
       <function>PQescapeByteaConn</>.
3453 3454 3455 3456 3457
<synopsis>
unsigned char *PQescapeBytea(const unsigned char *from,
                             size_t from_length,
                             size_t *to_length);
</synopsis>
3458
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3459

3460 3461 3462 3463 3464 3465 3466 3467 3468
      <para>
       The only difference from <function>PQescapeByteaConn</> is that
       <function>PQescapeBytea</> does not take a <structname>PGconn</>
       parameter.  Because of this, it cannot adjust its behavior
       depending on the connection properties (in particular, whether
       standard-conforming strings are enabled) and therefore
       <emphasis>it might give the wrong results</>.  Also, it has no
       way to return an error message on failure.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3469

3470 3471 3472 3473 3474 3475 3476 3477 3478 3479
      <para>
       <function>PQescapeBytea</> can be used safely in single-threaded
       client programs that work with only one <productname>PostgreSQL</>
       connection at a time (in this case it can find out what it needs
       to know <quote>behind the scenes</>).  In other contexts it is
       a security hazard and should be avoided in favor of
       <function>PQescapeByteaConn</>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3480

3481
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqunescapebytea">
3482 3483 3484 3485 3486 3487 3488 3489 3490 3491 3492 3493 3494
     <term>
      <function>PQunescapeBytea</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQunescapeBytea</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Converts a string representation of binary data into binary data
       &mdash; the reverse of <function>PQescapeBytea</function>.  This
       is needed when retrieving <type>bytea</type> data in text format,
       but not when retrieving it in binary format.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3495

3496 3497 3498
<synopsis>
unsigned char *PQunescapeBytea(const unsigned char *from, size_t *to_length);
</synopsis>
3499
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3500

3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506
      <para>
       The <parameter>from</parameter> parameter points to a string
       such as might be returned by <function>PQgetvalue</function> when applied
       to a <type>bytea</type> column. <function>PQunescapeBytea</function>
       converts this string representation into its binary representation.
       It returns a pointer to a buffer allocated with
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
3507
       <function>malloc()</function>, or <symbol>NULL</> on error, and puts the size of
3508 3509 3510
       the buffer in <parameter>to_length</parameter>. The result must be
       freed using <function>PQfreemem</> when it is no longer needed.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3511

3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520 3521
      <para>
       This conversion is not exactly the inverse of
       <function>PQescapeBytea</function>, because the string is not expected
       to be <quote>escaped</> when received from <function>PQgetvalue</function>.
       In particular this means there is no need for string quoting considerations,
       and so no need for a <structname>PGconn</> parameter.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3522

3523 3524 3525
  </sect2>

 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3526

3527 3528
 <sect1 id="libpq-async">
  <title>Asynchronous Command Processing</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3529

3530 3531 3532
  <indexterm zone="libpq-async">
   <primary>nonblocking connection</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3533

3534 3535 3536 3537
  <para>
   The <function>PQexec</function> function is adequate for submitting
   commands in normal, synchronous applications.  It has a couple of
   deficiencies, however, that can be of importance to some users:
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3538

3539 3540 3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546 3547 3548 3549 3550 3551 3552 3553 3554 3555 3556
   <itemizedlist>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <function>PQexec</function> waits for the command to be completed.
      The application might have other work to do (such as maintaining a
      user interface), in which case it won't want to block waiting for
      the response.
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Since the execution of the client application is suspended while it
      waits for the result, it is hard for the application to decide that
      it would like to try to cancel the ongoing command.  (It can be done
      from a signal handler, but not otherwise.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3557

3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <function>PQexec</function> can return only one
      <structname>PGresult</structname> structure.  If the submitted command
      string contains multiple <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands, all but
      the last <structname>PGresult</structname> are discarded by
      <function>PQexec</function>.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </itemizedlist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3569

3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587
  <para>
   Applications that do not like these limitations can instead use the
   underlying functions that <function>PQexec</function> is built from:
   <function>PQsendQuery</function> and <function>PQgetResult</function>.
   There are also
   <function>PQsendQueryParams</function>,
   <function>PQsendPrepare</function>,
   <function>PQsendQueryPrepared</function>,
   <function>PQsendDescribePrepared</function>, and
   <function>PQsendDescribePortal</function>,
   which can be used with <function>PQgetResult</function> to duplicate
   the functionality of
   <function>PQexecParams</function>,
   <function>PQprepare</function>,
   <function>PQexecPrepared</function>,
   <function>PQdescribePrepared</function>, and
   <function>PQdescribePortal</function>
   respectively.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3588

3589
   <variablelist>
3590
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsendquery">
3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601 3602 3603
     <term>
      <function>PQsendQuery</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendQuery</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Submits a command to the server without waiting for the result(s).
       1 is returned if the command was successfully dispatched and 0 if
       not (in which case, use <function>PQerrorMessage</> to get more
       information about the failure).
3604 3605 3606
<synopsis>
int PQsendQuery(PGconn *conn, const char *command);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3607

3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615
       After successfully calling <function>PQsendQuery</function>, call
       <function>PQgetResult</function> one or more times to obtain the
       results.  <function>PQsendQuery</function> cannot be called again
       (on the same connection) until <function>PQgetResult</function>
       has returned a null pointer, indicating that the command is done.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3616

3617
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsendqueryparams">
3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628
     <term>
      <function>PQsendQueryParams</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendQueryParams</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Submits a command and separate parameters to the server without
       waiting for the result(s).
3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638
<synopsis>
int PQsendQueryParams(PGconn *conn,
                      const char *command,
                      int nParams,
                      const Oid *paramTypes,
                      const char * const *paramValues,
                      const int *paramLengths,
                      const int *paramFormats,
                      int resultFormat);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3639

3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647 3648
       This is equivalent to <function>PQsendQuery</function> except that
       query parameters can be specified separately from the query string.
       The function's parameters are handled identically to
       <function>PQexecParams</function>.  Like
       <function>PQexecParams</function>, it will not work on 2.0-protocol
       connections, and it allows only one command in the query string.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3649

3650
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsendprepare">
3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659 3660 3661
     <term>
      <function>PQsendPrepare</>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendPrepare</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends a request to create a prepared statement with the given
       parameters, without waiting for completion.
3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668
<synopsis>
int PQsendPrepare(PGconn *conn,
                  const char *stmtName,
                  const char *query,
                  int nParams,
                  const Oid *paramTypes);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3669

3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680
       This is an asynchronous version of <function>PQprepare</>: it
       returns 1 if it was able to dispatch the request, and 0 if not.
       After a successful call, call <function>PQgetResult</function> to
       determine whether the server successfully created the prepared
       statement.  The function's parameters are handled identically to
       <function>PQprepare</function>.  Like
       <function>PQprepare</function>, it will not work on 2.0-protocol
       connections.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3681

3682
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsendqueryprepared">
3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692 3693
     <term>
      <function>PQsendQueryPrepared</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendQueryPrepared</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends a request to execute a prepared statement with given
       parameters, without waiting for the result(s).
3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701 3702
<synopsis>
int PQsendQueryPrepared(PGconn *conn,
                        const char *stmtName,
                        int nParams,
                        const char * const *paramValues,
                        const int *paramLengths,
                        const int *paramFormats,
                        int resultFormat);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3703

3704 3705 3706 3707 3708 3709 3710 3711 3712 3713
       This is similar to <function>PQsendQueryParams</function>, but
       the command to be executed is specified by naming a
       previously-prepared statement, instead of giving a query string.
       The function's parameters are handled identically to
       <function>PQexecPrepared</function>.  Like
       <function>PQexecPrepared</function>, it will not work on
       2.0-protocol connections.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3714

3715
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsenddescribeprepared">
3716 3717 3718 3719 3720 3721 3722 3723 3724 3725 3726
     <term>
      <function>PQsendDescribePrepared</>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendDescribePrepared</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Submits a request to obtain information about the specified
       prepared statement, without waiting for completion.
3727 3728 3729
<synopsis>
int PQsendDescribePrepared(PGconn *conn, const char *stmtName);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3730

3731 3732 3733 3734 3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740
       This is an asynchronous version of <function>PQdescribePrepared</>:
       it returns 1 if it was able to dispatch the request, and 0 if not.
       After a successful call, call <function>PQgetResult</function> to
       obtain the results.  The function's parameters are handled
       identically to <function>PQdescribePrepared</function>.  Like
       <function>PQdescribePrepared</function>, it will not work on
       2.0-protocol connections.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3741

3742
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsenddescribeportal">
3743 3744 3745 3746 3747 3748 3749 3750 3751 3752 3753
     <term>
      <function>PQsendDescribePortal</>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsendDescribePortal</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Submits a request to obtain information about the specified
       portal, without waiting for completion.
3754 3755 3756
<synopsis>
int PQsendDescribePortal(PGconn *conn, const char *portalName);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3757

3758 3759 3760 3761 3762 3763 3764 3765 3766 3767
       This is an asynchronous version of <function>PQdescribePortal</>:
       it returns 1 if it was able to dispatch the request, and 0 if not.
       After a successful call, call <function>PQgetResult</function> to
       obtain the results.  The function's parameters are handled
       identically to <function>PQdescribePortal</function>.  Like
       <function>PQdescribePortal</function>, it will not work on
       2.0-protocol connections.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3768

3769
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetresult">
3770 3771 3772 3773 3774 3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780 3781 3782 3783 3784 3785
     <term>
      <function>PQgetResult</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetResult</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Waits for the next result from a prior
       <function>PQsendQuery</function>,
       <function>PQsendQueryParams</function>,
       <function>PQsendPrepare</function>, or
       <function>PQsendQueryPrepared</function> call, and returns it.
       A null pointer is returned when the command is complete and there
       will be no more results.
3786 3787 3788
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQgetResult(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
3789
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3790

3791 3792 3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798 3799 3800 3801 3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808
      <para>
       <function>PQgetResult</function> must be called repeatedly until
       it returns a null pointer, indicating that the command is done.
       (If called when no command is active,
       <function>PQgetResult</function> will just return a null pointer
       at once.) Each non-null result from
       <function>PQgetResult</function> should be processed using the
       same <structname>PGresult</> accessor functions previously
       described.  Don't forget to free each result object with
       <function>PQclear</function> when done with it.  Note that
       <function>PQgetResult</function> will block only if a command is
       active and the necessary response data has not yet been read by
       <function>PQconsumeInput</function>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3809

3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820 3821
  <para>
   Using <function>PQsendQuery</function> and
   <function>PQgetResult</function> solves one of
   <function>PQexec</function>'s problems:  If a command string contains
   multiple <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands, the results of those commands
   can be obtained individually.  (This allows a simple form of overlapped
   processing, by the way: the client can be handling the results of one
   command while the server is still working on later queries in the same
   command string.)  However, calling <function>PQgetResult</function>
   will still cause the client to block until the server completes the
   next <acronym>SQL</acronym> command.  This can be avoided by proper
   use of two more functions:
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3822

3823
   <variablelist>
3824
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconsumeinput">
3825 3826 3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834
     <term>
      <function>PQconsumeInput</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQconsumeInput</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       If input is available from the server, consume it.
3835 3836 3837
<synopsis>
int PQconsumeInput(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
3838
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3839

3840 3841 3842 3843 3844 3845 3846 3847 3848 3849 3850 3851 3852 3853 3854 3855 3856 3857 3858 3859 3860 3861 3862
      <para>
       <function>PQconsumeInput</function> normally returns 1 indicating
       <quote>no error</quote>, but returns 0 if there was some kind of
       trouble (in which case <function>PQerrorMessage</function> can be
       consulted).  Note that the result does not say whether any input
       data was actually collected. After calling
       <function>PQconsumeInput</function>, the application can check
       <function>PQisBusy</function> and/or
       <function>PQnotifies</function> to see if their state has changed.
      </para>

      <para>
       <function>PQconsumeInput</function> can be called even if the
       application is not prepared to deal with a result or notification
       just yet.  The function will read available data and save it in
       a buffer, thereby causing a <function>select()</function>
       read-ready indication to go away.  The application can thus use
       <function>PQconsumeInput</function> to clear the
       <function>select()</function> condition immediately, and then
       examine the results at leisure.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3863

3864
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqisbusy">
3865 3866 3867 3868 3869 3870 3871 3872 3873 3874 3875 3876 3877
     <term>
      <function>PQisBusy</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQisBusy</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns 1 if a command is busy, that is,
       <function>PQgetResult</function> would block waiting for input.
       A 0 return indicates that <function>PQgetResult</function> can be
       called with assurance of not blocking.
3878 3879 3880
<synopsis>
int PQisBusy(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
3881
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3882

3883 3884 3885 3886 3887 3888 3889 3890 3891
      <para>
       <function>PQisBusy</function> will not itself attempt to read data
       from the server; therefore <function>PQconsumeInput</function>
       must be invoked first, or the busy state will never end.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3892

3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907
  <para>
   A typical application using these functions will have a main loop that
   uses <function>select()</function> or <function>poll()</> to wait for
   all the conditions that it must respond to.  One of the conditions
   will be input available from the server, which in terms of
   <function>select()</function> means readable data on the file
   descriptor identified by <function>PQsocket</function>.  When the main
   loop detects input ready, it should call
   <function>PQconsumeInput</function> to read the input.  It can then
   call <function>PQisBusy</function>, followed by
   <function>PQgetResult</function> if <function>PQisBusy</function>
   returns false (0).  It can also call <function>PQnotifies</function>
   to detect <command>NOTIFY</> messages (see <xref
   linkend="libpq-notify">).
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3908

3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919
  <para>
   A client that uses
   <function>PQsendQuery</function>/<function>PQgetResult</function>
   can also attempt to cancel a command that is still being processed
   by the server; see <xref linkend="libpq-cancel">.  But regardless of
   the return value of <function>PQcancel</function>, the application
   must continue with the normal result-reading sequence using
   <function>PQgetResult</function>.  A successful cancellation will
   simply cause the command to terminate sooner than it would have
   otherwise.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3920

3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926 3927 3928 3929 3930
  <para>
   By using the functions described above, it is possible to avoid
   blocking while waiting for input from the database server.  However,
   it is still possible that the application will block waiting to send
   output to the server.  This is relatively uncommon but can happen if
   very long SQL commands or data values are sent.  (It is much more
   probable if the application sends data via <command>COPY IN</command>,
   however.)  To prevent this possibility and achieve completely
   nonblocking database operation, the following additional functions
   can be used.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3931

3932
   <variablelist>
3933
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetnonblocking">
3934 3935 3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943
     <term>
      <function>PQsetnonblocking</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsetnonblocking</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sets the nonblocking status of the connection.
3944 3945 3946
<synopsis>
int PQsetnonblocking(PGconn *conn, int arg);
</synopsis>
3947
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3948

3949 3950 3951 3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957 3958 3959 3960 3961 3962 3963 3964 3965 3966 3967 3968
      <para>
       Sets the state of the connection to nonblocking if
       <parameter>arg</parameter> is 1, or blocking if
       <parameter>arg</parameter> is 0.  Returns 0 if OK, -1 if error.
      </para>

      <para>
       In the nonblocking state, calls to
       <function>PQsendQuery</function>, <function>PQputline</function>,
       <function>PQputnbytes</function>, and
       <function>PQendcopy</function> will not block but instead return
       an error if they need to be called again.
      </para>

      <para>
       Note that <function>PQexec</function> does not honor nonblocking
       mode; if it is called, it will act in blocking fashion anyway.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3969

3970
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqisnonblocking">
3971 3972 3973 3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979 3980
     <term>
      <function>PQisnonblocking</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQisnonblocking</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the blocking status of the database connection.
3981 3982 3983
<synopsis>
int PQisnonblocking(const PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
3984
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3985

3986 3987 3988 3989 3990 3991
      <para>
       Returns 1 if the connection is set to nonblocking mode and 0 if
       blocking.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
3992

3993
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqflush">
3994 3995 3996 3997 3998 3999 4000 4001 4002 4003 4004 4005 4006 4007
     <term>
      <function>PQflush</function>
       <indexterm>
        <primary>PQflush</primary>
       </indexterm>
      </term>

      <listitem>
       <para>
       Attempts to flush any queued output data to the server.  Returns
       0 if successful (or if the send queue is empty), -1 if it failed
       for some reason, or 1 if it was unable to send all the data in
       the send queue yet (this case can only occur if the connection
       is nonblocking).
4008 4009 4010
<synopsis>
int PQflush(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
4011 4012 4013 4014 4015
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4016

4017 4018 4019 4020 4021 4022 4023
  <para>
   After sending any command or data on a nonblocking connection, call
   <function>PQflush</function>.  If it returns 1, wait for the socket
   to be write-ready and call it again; repeat until it returns 0.  Once
   <function>PQflush</function> returns 0, wait for the socket to be
   read-ready and then read the response as described above.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4024

4025
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4026

4027 4028
 <sect1 id="libpq-cancel">
  <title>Cancelling Queries in Progress</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4029

4030 4031 4032
  <indexterm zone="libpq-cancel">
   <primary>canceling</primary>
   <secondary>SQL command</secondary>
4033
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4034

4035 4036 4037 4038
  <para>
   A client application can request cancellation of a command that is
   still being processed by the server, using the functions described in
   this section.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4039

4040
   <variablelist>
4041
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetcancel">
4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047 4048 4049 4050 4051 4052
     <term>
      <function>PQgetCancel</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetCancel</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Creates a data structure containing the information needed to cancel
       a command issued through a particular database connection.
4053 4054 4055
<synopsis>
PGcancel *PQgetCancel(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
4056
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4057

4058 4059 4060 4061
      <para>
       <function>PQgetCancel</function> creates a
       <structname>PGcancel</><indexterm><primary>PGcancel</></> object
       given a <structname>PGconn</> connection object.  It will return
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
4062
       <symbol>NULL</> if the given <parameter>conn</> is <symbol>NULL</> or an invalid
4063 4064 4065 4066 4067 4068 4069 4070
       connection.  The <structname>PGcancel</> object is an opaque
       structure that is not meant to be accessed directly by the
       application; it can only be passed to <function>PQcancel</function>
       or <function>PQfreeCancel</function>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

4071
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfreecancel">
4072 4073 4074 4075 4076 4077 4078 4079 4080 4081
     <term>
      <function>PQfreeCancel</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfreeCancel</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Frees a data structure created by <function>PQgetCancel</function>.
4082 4083 4084
<synopsis>
void PQfreeCancel(PGcancel *cancel);
</synopsis>
4085
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4086

4087 4088 4089 4090 4091 4092
      <para>
       <function>PQfreeCancel</function> frees a data object previously created
       by <function>PQgetCancel</function>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4093

4094
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqcancel">
4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102 4103 4104
     <term>
      <function>PQcancel</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQcancel</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Requests that the server abandon processing of the current command.
4105 4106 4107
<synopsis>
int PQcancel(PGcancel *cancel, char *errbuf, int errbufsize);
</synopsis>
4108
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4109

4110 4111 4112 4113 4114 4115 4116
      <para>
       The return value is 1 if the cancel request was successfully
       dispatched and 0 if not.  If not, <parameter>errbuf</> is filled
       with an error message explaining why not.  <parameter>errbuf</>
       must be a char array of size <parameter>errbufsize</> (the
       recommended size is 256 bytes).
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4117

4118 4119 4120 4121 4122 4123 4124 4125
      <para>
       Successful dispatch is no guarantee that the request will have
       any effect, however.  If the cancellation is effective, the current
       command will terminate early and return an error result.  If the
       cancellation fails (say, because the server was already done
       processing the command), then there will be no visible result at
       all.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4126

4127 4128 4129 4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137
      <para>
       <function>PQcancel</function> can safely be invoked from a signal
       handler, if the <parameter>errbuf</> is a local variable in the
       signal handler.  The <structname>PGcancel</> object is read-only
       as far as <function>PQcancel</function> is concerned, so it can
       also be invoked from a thread that is separate from the one
       manipulating the <structname>PGconn</> object.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4138

4139
   <variablelist>
4140
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqrequestcancel">
4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151
     <term>
      <function>PQrequestCancel</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQrequestCancel</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Requests that the server abandon processing of the current
       command.
4152 4153 4154
<synopsis>
int PQrequestCancel(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
4155
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4156

4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169 4170 4171
      <para>
       <function>PQrequestCancel</function> is a deprecated variant of
       <function>PQcancel</function>.  It operates directly on the
       <structname>PGconn</> object, and in case of failure stores the
       error message in the <structname>PGconn</> object (whence it can
       be retrieved by <function>PQerrorMessage</function>).  Although
       the functionality is the same, this approach creates hazards for
       multiple-thread programs and signal handlers, since it is possible
       that overwriting the <structname>PGconn</>'s error message will
       mess up the operation currently in progress on the connection.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4172

4173
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4174

4175 4176
 <sect1 id="libpq-fastpath">
  <title>The Fast-Path Interface</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4177

4178 4179 4180
  <indexterm zone="libpq-fastpath">
   <primary>fast path</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4181

4182 4183 4184 4185
  <para>
   <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> provides a fast-path interface
   to send simple function calls to the server.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4186

4187 4188 4189 4190 4191 4192 4193 4194 4195
  <tip>
   <para>
    This interface is somewhat obsolete, as one can achieve similar
    performance and greater functionality by setting up a prepared
    statement to define the function call.  Then, executing the statement
    with binary transmission of parameters and results substitutes for a
    fast-path function call.
   </para>
  </tip>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4196

4197 4198 4199
  <para>
   The function <function>PQfn</function><indexterm><primary>PQfn</></>
   requests execution of a server function via the fast-path interface:
4200 4201 4202 4203 4204 4205 4206 4207 4208 4209 4210 4211 4212 4213 4214 4215 4216 4217 4218 4219
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQfn(PGconn *conn,
               int fnid,
               int *result_buf,
               int *result_len,
               int result_is_int,
               const PQArgBlock *args,
               int nargs);

typedef struct
{
    int len;
    int isint;
    union
    {
        int *ptr;
        int integer;
    } u;
} PQArgBlock;
</synopsis>
4220
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4221

4222 4223 4224 4225 4226 4227 4228 4229 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234 4235 4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244
  <para>
   The <parameter>fnid</> argument is the OID of the function to be
   executed.  <parameter>args</> and <parameter>nargs</> define the
   parameters to be passed to the function; they must match the declared
   function argument list.  When the <parameter>isint</> field of a
   parameter structure is true, the <parameter>u.integer</> value is sent
   to the server as an integer of the indicated length (this must be 1,
   2, or 4 bytes); proper byte-swapping occurs.  When <parameter>isint</>
   is false, the indicated number of bytes at <parameter>*u.ptr</> are
   sent with no processing; the data must be in the format expected by
   the server for binary transmission of the function's argument data
   type.  <parameter>result_buf</parameter> is the buffer in which to
   place the return value.  The caller must  have  allocated sufficient
   space to store the return value.  (There is no check!) The actual result
   length will be returned in the integer pointed to  by
   <parameter>result_len</parameter>.  If a 1, 2, or 4-byte integer result
   is expected, set <parameter>result_is_int</parameter> to 1, otherwise
   set it to 0.  Setting <parameter>result_is_int</parameter> to 1 causes
   <application>libpq</> to byte-swap the value if necessary, so that it
   is delivered as a proper <type>int</type> value for the client machine.
   When <parameter>result_is_int</> is 0, the binary-format byte string
   sent by the server is returned unmodified.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4245

4246 4247 4248 4249 4250 4251 4252
  <para>
   <function>PQfn</function> always returns a valid
   <structname>PGresult</structname> pointer. The result status should be
   checked before the result is used.   The caller is responsible for
   freeing  the  <structname>PGresult</structname>  with
   <function>PQclear</function> when it is no longer needed.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4253

4254 4255 4256 4257
  <para>
   Note that it is not possible to handle null arguments, null results,
   nor set-valued results when using this interface.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4258

4259
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4260

4261 4262
 <sect1 id="libpq-notify">
  <title>Asynchronous Notification</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4263

4264 4265 4266 4267
  <indexterm zone="libpq-notify">
   <primary>NOTIFY</primary>
   <secondary>in libpq</secondary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4268

4269 4270 4271 4272
  <para>
   <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers asynchronous notification
   via the <command>LISTEN</command> and <command>NOTIFY</command>
   commands.  A client session registers its interest in a particular
4273
   notification channel with the <command>LISTEN</command> command (and
4274
   can stop listening with the <command>UNLISTEN</command> command).  All
4275
   sessions listening on a particular channel will be notified
4276
   asynchronously when a <command>NOTIFY</command> command with that
4277 4278
   channel name is executed by any session. A <quote>payload</> string can
   be passed to communicate additional data to the listeners.
4279
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4280

4281 4282
  <para>
   <application>libpq</application> applications submit
4283 4284
   <command>LISTEN</command>, <command>UNLISTEN</command>,
   and <command>NOTIFY</command> commands as
4285 4286 4287 4288
   ordinary SQL commands.  The arrival of <command>NOTIFY</command>
   messages can subsequently be detected by calling
   <function>PQnotifies</function>.<indexterm><primary>PQnotifies</></>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4289

4290
  <para>
4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296
   The function <function>PQnotifies</function> returns the next notification
   from a list of unhandled notification messages received from the server.
   It returns a null pointer if there are no pending notifications.  Once a
   notification is returned from <function>PQnotifies</>, it is considered
   handled and will be removed from the list of notifications.

4297 4298
<synopsis>
PGnotify *PQnotifies(PGconn *conn);
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4299

4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306
typedef struct pgNotify
{
    char *relname;              /* notification channel name */
    int  be_pid;                /* process ID of notifying server process */
    char *extra;                /* notification payload string */
} PGnotify;
</synopsis>
4307

4308 4309 4310 4311 4312
   After processing a <structname>PGnotify</structname> object returned
   by <function>PQnotifies</function>, be sure to free it with
   <function>PQfreemem</function>.  It is sufficient to free the
   <structname>PGnotify</structname> pointer; the
   <structfield>relname</structfield> and <structfield>extra</structfield>
4313 4314 4315
   fields do not represent separate allocations.  (The names of these fields
   are historical; in particular, channel names need not have anything to
   do with relation names.)
4316
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4317

4318 4319 4320 4321
  <para>
   <xref linkend="libpq-example-2"> gives a sample program that illustrates
   the use of asynchronous notification.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4322

4323 4324 4325 4326 4327 4328 4329 4330 4331 4332
  <para>
   <function>PQnotifies</function> does not actually read data from the
   server; it just returns messages previously absorbed by another
   <application>libpq</application> function.  In prior releases of
   <application>libpq</application>, the only way to ensure timely receipt
   of <command>NOTIFY</> messages was to constantly submit commands, even
   empty ones, and then check <function>PQnotifies</function> after each
   <function>PQexec</function>.  While this still works, it is deprecated
   as a waste of processing power.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4333

4334 4335 4336 4337 4338 4339 4340 4341 4342 4343 4344 4345 4346 4347 4348 4349
  <para>
   A better way to check for <command>NOTIFY</> messages when you have no
   useful commands to execute is to call
   <function>PQconsumeInput</function>, then check
   <function>PQnotifies</function>.  You can use
   <function>select()</function> to wait for data to arrive from the
   server, thereby using no <acronym>CPU</acronym> power unless there is
   something to do.  (See <function>PQsocket</function> to obtain the file
   descriptor number to use with <function>select()</function>.) Note that
   this will work OK whether you submit commands with
   <function>PQsendQuery</function>/<function>PQgetResult</function> or
   simply use <function>PQexec</function>.  You should, however, remember
   to check <function>PQnotifies</function> after each
   <function>PQgetResult</function> or <function>PQexec</function>, to
   see if any notifications came in during the processing of the command.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4350

4351
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4352

4353 4354
 <sect1 id="libpq-copy">
  <title>Functions Associated with the <command>COPY</command> Command</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4355

4356 4357 4358 4359
  <indexterm zone="libpq-copy">
   <primary>COPY</primary>
   <secondary>with libpq</secondary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4360

4361 4362 4363 4364 4365 4366 4367
  <para>
   The <command>COPY</command> command in
   <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> has options to read from or write
   to the network connection used by <application>libpq</application>.
   The functions described in this section allow applications to take
   advantage of this capability by supplying or consuming copied data.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4368

4369 4370 4371 4372 4373 4374 4375 4376 4377 4378 4379 4380 4381 4382 4383 4384 4385 4386
  <para>
   The overall process is that the application first issues the SQL
   <command>COPY</command> command via <function>PQexec</function> or one
   of the equivalent functions.  The response to this (if there is no
   error in the command) will be a <structname>PGresult</> object bearing
   a status code of <literal>PGRES_COPY_OUT</literal> or
   <literal>PGRES_COPY_IN</literal> (depending on the specified copy
   direction).  The application should then use the functions of this
   section to receive or transmit data rows.  When the data transfer is
   complete, another <structname>PGresult</> object is returned to indicate
   success or failure of the transfer.  Its status will be
   <literal>PGRES_COMMAND_OK</literal> for success or
   <literal>PGRES_FATAL_ERROR</literal> if some problem was encountered.
   At this point further SQL commands can be issued via
   <function>PQexec</function>.  (It is not possible to execute other SQL
   commands using the same connection while the <command>COPY</command>
   operation is in progress.)
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4387

4388 4389 4390 4391 4392 4393 4394 4395 4396
  <para>
   If a <command>COPY</command> command is issued via
   <function>PQexec</function> in a string that could contain additional
   commands, the application must continue fetching results via
   <function>PQgetResult</> after completing the <command>COPY</command>
   sequence.  Only when <function>PQgetResult</> returns
   <symbol>NULL</symbol> is it certain that the <function>PQexec</function>
   command string is done and it is safe to issue more commands.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4397

4398 4399 4400 4401 4402 4403
  <para>
   The functions of this section should be executed only after obtaining
   a result status of <literal>PGRES_COPY_OUT</literal> or
   <literal>PGRES_COPY_IN</literal> from <function>PQexec</function> or
   <function>PQgetResult</function>.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4404

4405 4406 4407 4408 4409
  <para>
   A <structname>PGresult</> object bearing one of these status values
   carries some additional data about the <command>COPY</command> operation
   that is starting.  This additional data is available using functions
   that are also used in connection with query results:
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4410

4411
   <variablelist>
4412
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqnfields-1">
4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418 4419 4420 4421 4422 4423 4424 4425 4426
     <term>
      <function>PQnfields</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQnfields</primary>
       <secondary>with COPY</secondary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the number of columns (fields) to be copied.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4427

4428
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqbinarytuples-1">
4429 4430 4431 4432 4433 4434 4435 4436 4437 4438 4439 4440 4441
     <term>
      <function>PQbinaryTuples</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQbinaryTuples</primary>
       <secondary>with COPY</secondary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       0 indicates the overall copy format is textual (rows separated by
       newlines, columns separated by separator characters, etc).  1
       indicates the overall copy format is binary.  See <xref
4442
       linkend="sql-copy"> for more information.
4443 4444 4445
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4446

4447
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfformat-1">
4448 4449 4450 4451 4452 4453 4454 4455 4456 4457 4458 4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468 4469
     <term>
      <function>PQfformat</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQfformat</primary>
       <secondary>with COPY</secondary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Returns the format code (0 for text, 1 for binary) associated with
       each column of the copy operation.  The per-column format codes
       will always be zero when the overall copy format is textual, but
       the binary format can support both text and binary columns.
       (However, as of the current implementation of <command>COPY</>,
       only binary columns appear in a binary copy; so the per-column
       formats always match the overall format at present.)
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4470

4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476
  <note>
   <para>
    These additional data values are only available when using protocol
    3.0.  When using protocol 2.0, all these functions will return 0.
   </para>
  </note>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4477

4478 4479
  <sect2 id="libpq-copy-send">
   <title>Functions for Sending <command>COPY</command> Data</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4480

4481 4482 4483 4484 4485
   <para>
    These functions are used to send data during <literal>COPY FROM
    STDIN</>.  They will fail if called when the connection is not in
    <literal>COPY_IN</> state.
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4486

4487
   <variablelist>
4488
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqputcopydata">
4489 4490 4491 4492 4493 4494 4495 4496 4497 4498
     <term>
      <function>PQputCopyData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQputCopyData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends data to the server during <literal>COPY_IN</> state.
4499 4500 4501 4502 4503
<synopsis>
int PQputCopyData(PGconn *conn,
                  const char *buffer,
                  int nbytes);
</synopsis>
4504
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4505

4506 4507 4508 4509 4510 4511 4512 4513 4514 4515
      <para>
       Transmits the <command>COPY</command> data in the specified
       <parameter>buffer</>, of length <parameter>nbytes</>, to the server.
       The result is 1 if the data was sent, zero if it was not sent
       because the attempt would block (this case is only possible if the
       connection is in nonblocking mode), or -1 if an error occurred.
       (Use <function>PQerrorMessage</function> to retrieve details if
       the return value is -1.  If the value is zero, wait for write-ready
       and try again.)
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4516

4517 4518 4519 4520 4521
      <para>
       The application can divide the <command>COPY</command> data stream
       into buffer loads of any convenient size.  Buffer-load boundaries
       have no semantic significance when sending.  The contents of the
       data stream must match the data format expected by the
4522
       <command>COPY</> command; see <xref linkend="sql-copy"> for details.
4523 4524 4525
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4526

4527
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqputcopyend">
4528 4529 4530 4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537
     <term>
      <function>PQputCopyEnd</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQputCopyEnd</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends end-of-data indication to the server during <literal>COPY_IN</> state.
4538 4539 4540 4541
<synopsis>
int PQputCopyEnd(PGconn *conn,
                 const char *errormsg);
</synopsis>
4542
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4543

4544 4545 4546 4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554 4555
      <para>
       Ends the <literal>COPY_IN</> operation successfully if
       <parameter>errormsg</> is <symbol>NULL</symbol>.  If
       <parameter>errormsg</> is not <symbol>NULL</symbol> then the
       <command>COPY</> is forced to fail, with the string pointed to by
       <parameter>errormsg</> used as the error message.  (One should not
       assume that this exact error message will come back from the server,
       however, as the server might have already failed the
       <command>COPY</> for its own reasons.  Also note that the option
       to force failure does not work when using pre-3.0-protocol
       connections.)
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4556

4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562 4563 4564
      <para>
       The result is 1 if the termination data was sent, zero if it was
       not sent because the attempt would block (this case is only possible
       if the connection is in nonblocking mode), or -1 if an error
       occurred.  (Use <function>PQerrorMessage</function> to retrieve
       details if the return value is -1.  If the value is zero, wait for
       write-ready and try again.)
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4565

4566 4567 4568 4569 4570 4571 4572 4573 4574
      <para>
       After successfully calling <function>PQputCopyEnd</>, call
       <function>PQgetResult</> to obtain the final result status of the
       <command>COPY</> command.  One can wait for this result to be
       available in the usual way.  Then return to normal operation.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4575

4576
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4577

4578 4579
  <sect2 id="libpq-copy-receive">
   <title>Functions for Receiving <command>COPY</command> Data</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4580

4581 4582 4583 4584 4585
   <para>
    These functions are used to receive data during <literal>COPY TO
    STDOUT</>.  They will fail if called when the connection is not in
    <literal>COPY_OUT</> state.
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4586

4587
   <variablelist>
4588
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetcopydata">
4589 4590 4591 4592 4593 4594 4595 4596 4597 4598
     <term>
      <function>PQgetCopyData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetCopyData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Receives data from the server during <literal>COPY_OUT</> state.
4599 4600 4601 4602 4603
<synopsis>
int PQgetCopyData(PGconn *conn,
                  char **buffer,
                  int async);
</synopsis>
4604
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4605

4606 4607 4608 4609 4610 4611 4612 4613 4614
      <para>
       Attempts to obtain another row of data from the server during a
       <command>COPY</command>.  Data is always returned one data row at
       a time; if only a partial row is available, it is not returned.
       Successful return of a data row involves allocating a chunk of
       memory to hold the data.  The <parameter>buffer</> parameter must
       be non-<symbol>NULL</symbol>.  <parameter>*buffer</> is set to
       point to the allocated memory, or to <symbol>NULL</symbol> in cases
       where no buffer is returned.  A non-<symbol>NULL</symbol> result
4615
       buffer should be freed using <function>PQfreemem</> when no longer
4616 4617
       needed.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4618

4619 4620 4621 4622 4623 4624 4625 4626 4627 4628 4629
      <para>
       When a row is successfully returned, the return value is the number
       of data bytes in the row (this will always be greater than zero).
       The returned string is always null-terminated, though this is
       probably only useful for textual <command>COPY</command>.  A result
       of zero indicates that the <command>COPY</command> is still in
       progress, but no row is yet available (this is only possible when
       <parameter>async</> is true).  A result of -1 indicates that the
       <command>COPY</command> is done.  A result of -2 indicates that an
       error occurred (consult <function>PQerrorMessage</> for the reason).
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4630

4631 4632 4633 4634 4635 4636 4637 4638 4639 4640
      <para>
       When <parameter>async</> is true (not zero),
       <function>PQgetCopyData</> will not block waiting for input; it
       will return zero if the <command>COPY</command> is still in progress
       but no complete row is available.  (In this case wait for read-ready
       and then call <function>PQconsumeInput</> before calling
       <function>PQgetCopyData</> again.)  When <parameter>async</> is
       false (zero), <function>PQgetCopyData</> will block until data is
       available or the operation completes.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4641

4642 4643 4644 4645 4646 4647 4648 4649 4650
      <para>
       After <function>PQgetCopyData</> returns -1, call
       <function>PQgetResult</> to obtain the final result status of the
       <command>COPY</> command.  One can wait for this result to be
       available in the usual way.  Then return to normal operation.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4651

4652
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4653

4654 4655
  <sect2 id="libpq-copy-deprecated">
   <title>Obsolete Functions for <command>COPY</command></title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4656

4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662
   <para>
    These functions represent older methods of handling <command>COPY</>.
    Although they still work, they are deprecated due to poor error handling,
    inconvenient methods of detecting end-of-data, and lack of support for binary
    or nonblocking transfers.
   </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4663

4664
   <variablelist>
4665
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetline">
4666 4667 4668 4669 4670 4671 4672 4673 4674 4675 4676
     <term>
      <function>PQgetline</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetline</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Reads  a  newline-terminated  line  of  characters (transmitted
       by the server) into a buffer string of size <parameter>length</>.
4677 4678 4679 4680 4681
<synopsis>
int PQgetline(PGconn *conn,
              char *buffer,
              int length);
</synopsis>
4682
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4683

4684 4685 4686 4687 4688 4689 4690 4691 4692 4693 4694 4695 4696 4697 4698 4699 4700 4701 4702
      <para>
       This function copies up to <parameter>length</>-1 characters into
       the buffer and converts the terminating newline into a zero byte.
       <function>PQgetline</function> returns <symbol>EOF</symbol> at the
       end of input, 0 if the entire line has been read, and 1 if the
       buffer is full but the terminating newline has not yet been read.
       </para>
       <para>
       Note that the application must check to see if a new line consists
       of  the  two characters  <literal>\.</literal>, which  indicates
       that the server has finished sending the results  of  the
       <command>COPY</command> command.  If  the  application might receive
       lines that are more than <parameter>length</>-1  characters  long,
       care is needed to be sure it recognizes the <literal>\.</literal>
       line correctly (and does not, for example, mistake the end of a
       long data line for a terminator line).
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4703

4704
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqgetlineasync">
4705 4706 4707 4708 4709 4710 4711 4712 4713 4714 4715
     <term>
      <function>PQgetlineAsync</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQgetlineAsync</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Reads a row of <command>COPY</command> data (transmitted  by the
       server) into a buffer without blocking.
4716 4717 4718 4719 4720
<synopsis>
int PQgetlineAsync(PGconn *conn,
                   char *buffer,
                   int bufsize);
</synopsis>
4721
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4722

4723 4724 4725 4726 4727 4728 4729 4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736 4737 4738 4739 4740 4741 4742 4743 4744 4745 4746 4747 4748 4749 4750 4751 4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761
      <para>
       This function is similar to <function>PQgetline</function>, but it can be used
       by applications
       that must read <command>COPY</command> data asynchronously, that is, without blocking.
       Having issued the <command>COPY</command> command and gotten a <literal>PGRES_COPY_OUT</literal>
       response, the
       application should call <function>PQconsumeInput</function> and
       <function>PQgetlineAsync</function> until the
       end-of-data signal is detected.
       </para>
       <para>
       Unlike <function>PQgetline</function>, this function takes
       responsibility for detecting end-of-data.
      </para>

      <para>
       On each call, <function>PQgetlineAsync</function> will return data if a
       complete data row is available in <application>libpq</>'s input buffer.
       Otherwise, no data is returned until the rest of the row arrives.
       The function returns -1 if the end-of-copy-data marker has been recognized,
       or 0 if no data is available, or a positive number giving the number of
       bytes of data returned.  If -1 is returned, the caller must next call
       <function>PQendcopy</function>, and then return to normal processing.
      </para>

      <para>
       The data returned will not extend beyond a data-row boundary.  If possible
       a whole row will be returned at one time.  But if the buffer offered by
       the caller is too small to hold a row sent by the server, then a partial
       data row will be returned.  With textual data this can be detected by testing
       whether the last returned byte is <literal>\n</literal> or not.  (In a binary
       <command>COPY</>, actual parsing of the <command>COPY</> data format will be needed to make the
       equivalent determination.)
       The returned string is not null-terminated.  (If you want to add a
       terminating null, be sure to pass a <parameter>bufsize</parameter> one smaller
       than the room actually available.)
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4762

4763
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqputline">
4764 4765 4766 4767 4768 4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774
     <term>
      <function>PQputline</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQputline</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends  a  null-terminated  string  to  the server.  Returns 0 if
       OK and <symbol>EOF</symbol> if unable to send the string.
4775 4776 4777 4778
<synopsis>
int PQputline(PGconn *conn,
              const char *string);
</synopsis>
4779
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4780

4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788
      <para>
       The <command>COPY</command> data stream sent by a series of calls
       to <function>PQputline</function> has the same format as that
       returned by <function>PQgetlineAsync</function>, except that
       applications are not obliged to send exactly one data row per
       <function>PQputline</function> call; it is okay to send a partial
       line or multiple lines per call.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4789

4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796 4797 4798 4799 4800 4801 4802
      <note>
       <para>
        Before <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> protocol 3.0, it was necessary
        for the application to explicitly send the two characters
        <literal>\.</literal> as a final line to indicate to the server that it had
        finished sending <command>COPY</> data.  While this still works, it is deprecated and the
        special meaning of <literal>\.</literal> can be expected to be removed in a
        future release.  It is sufficient to call <function>PQendcopy</function> after
        having sent the actual data.
       </para>
      </note>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4803

4804
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqputnbytes">
4805 4806 4807 4808 4809 4810
     <term>
      <function>PQputnbytes</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQputnbytes</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
4811

4812 4813 4814 4815
     <listitem>
      <para>
       Sends  a  non-null-terminated  string  to  the server.  Returns
       0 if OK and <symbol>EOF</symbol> if unable to send the string.
4816 4817 4818 4819 4820
<synopsis>
int PQputnbytes(PGconn *conn,
                const char *buffer,
                int nbytes);
</synopsis>
4821
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4822

4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828 4829
      <para>
       This is exactly like <function>PQputline</function>, except that the data
       buffer need not be null-terminated since the number of bytes to send is
       specified directly.  Use this procedure when sending binary data.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4830

4831
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqendcopy">
4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841
     <term>
      <function>PQendcopy</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQendcopy</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Synchronizes with the server.
4842 4843 4844
<synopsis>
int PQendcopy(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851 4852 4853 4854 4855
       This function waits until the  server  has  finished  the copying.
       It should either be issued when the  last  string  has  been sent
       to  the  server using <function>PQputline</function> or when the
       last string has been  received  from  the  server using
       <function>PGgetline</function>.  It must be issued or the server
       will get <quote>out of sync</quote> with  the client.   Upon return
       from this function, the server is ready to receive the next SQL
       command.  The return value is 0  on  successful  completion,
       nonzero otherwise.  (Use <function>PQerrorMessage</function> to
       retrieve details if the return value is nonzero.)
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4856

4857 4858 4859 4860 4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866 4867 4868 4869 4870
      <para>
       When using <function>PQgetResult</function>, the application should
       respond to a <literal>PGRES_COPY_OUT</literal> result by executing
       <function>PQgetline</function> repeatedly, followed by
       <function>PQendcopy</function> after the terminator line is seen.
       It should then return to the <function>PQgetResult</function> loop
       until <function>PQgetResult</function> returns a null pointer.
       Similarly a <literal>PGRES_COPY_IN</literal> result is processed
       by a series of <function>PQputline</function> calls followed by
       <function>PQendcopy</function>, then return to the
       <function>PQgetResult</function> loop.  This arrangement will
       ensure that a <command>COPY</command> command embedded in a series
       of <acronym>SQL</acronym> commands will be executed correctly.
      </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4871

4872 4873 4874 4875 4876 4877 4878 4879 4880 4881
      <para>
       Older applications are likely to submit a <command>COPY</command>
       via <function>PQexec</function> and assume that the transaction
       is done after <function>PQendcopy</function>.  This will work
       correctly only if the <command>COPY</command> is the only
       <acronym>SQL</acronym> command in the command string.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4882

4883
  </sect2>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4884

4885
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4886

4887 4888
 <sect1 id="libpq-control">
  <title>Control Functions</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4889

4890 4891 4892 4893
  <para>
   These functions control miscellaneous details of <application>libpq</>'s
   behavior.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4894

4895
  <variablelist>
4896
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqclientencoding">
4897 4898 4899 4900 4901 4902 4903 4904 4905 4906
    <term>
     <function>PQclientEncoding</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQclientEncoding</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Returns the client encoding.
4907 4908 4909
<synopsis>
int PQclientEncoding(const PGconn *<replaceable>conn</replaceable>);
</synopsis>
4910 4911 4912 4913 4914 4915 4916 4917 4918 4919 4920 4921

      Note that it returns the encoding ID, not a symbolic string
      such as <literal>EUC_JP</literal>. To convert an encoding ID to an encoding name, you
      can use:

<synopsis>
char *pg_encoding_to_char(int <replaceable>encoding_id</replaceable>);
</synopsis>
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

4922
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetclientencoding">
4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930 4931 4932
    <term>
     <function>PQsetClientEncoding</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQsetClientEncoding</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Sets the client encoding.
4933 4934 4935
<synopsis>
int PQsetClientEncoding(PGconn *<replaceable>conn</replaceable>, const char *<replaceable>encoding</replaceable>);
</synopsis>
4936 4937 4938 4939 4940 4941 4942 4943 4944 4945

      <replaceable>conn</replaceable> is a connection to the server,
      and <replaceable>encoding</replaceable> is the encoding you want to
      use. If the function successfully sets the encoding, it returns 0,
      otherwise -1. The current encoding for this connection can be
      determined by using <function>PQclientEncoding</>.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

4946
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqseterrorverbosity">
4947 4948 4949 4950 4951 4952 4953
    <term>
     <function>PQsetErrorVerbosity</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQsetErrorVerbosity</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4954 4955 4956 4957
    <listitem>
     <para>
      Determines the verbosity of messages returned by
      <function>PQerrorMessage</> and <function>PQresultErrorMessage</>.
4958 4959 4960 4961 4962 4963 4964
<synopsis>
typedef enum
{
    PQERRORS_TERSE,
    PQERRORS_DEFAULT,
    PQERRORS_VERBOSE
} PGVerbosity;
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4965

4966 4967
PGVerbosity PQsetErrorVerbosity(PGconn *conn, PGVerbosity verbosity);
</synopsis>
4968

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4969 4970 4971 4972 4973 4974 4975 4976 4977 4978 4979 4980
      <function>PQsetErrorVerbosity</> sets the verbosity mode, returning
      the connection's previous setting.  In <firstterm>TERSE</> mode,
      returned messages include severity, primary text, and position only;
      this will normally fit on a single line.  The default mode produces
      messages that include the above plus any detail, hint, or context
      fields (these might span multiple lines).  The <firstterm>VERBOSE</>
      mode includes all available fields.  Changing the verbosity does not
      affect the messages available from already-existing
      <structname>PGresult</> objects, only subsequently-created ones.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4981

4982
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqtrace">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4983 4984 4985 4986 4987 4988
    <term>
     <function>PQtrace</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQtrace</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4989

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4990
    <listitem>
4991
     <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4992
      Enables  tracing of the client/server communication to a debugging file stream.
4993 4994 4995
<synopsis>
void PQtrace(PGconn *conn, FILE *stream);
</synopsis>
4996
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4997

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
4998 4999 5000 5001 5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007
     <note>
      <para>
       On Windows, if the <application>libpq</> library and an application are
       compiled with different flags, this function call will crash the
       application because the internal representation of the <literal>FILE</>
       pointers differ.  Specifically, multithreaded/single-threaded,
       release/debug, and static/dynamic flags should be the same for the
       library and all applications using that library.
      </para>
     </note>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5008

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5009 5010
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5011

5012
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pquntrace">
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5013 5014 5015 5016 5017 5018
    <term>
     <function>PQuntrace</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQuntrace</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5019

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5020 5021 5022
    <listitem>
     <para>
      Disables tracing started by <function>PQtrace</function>.
5023 5024 5025
<synopsis>
void PQuntrace(PGconn *conn);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5026 5027 5028 5029
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>
  </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5030

5031
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5032

5033 5034
 <sect1 id="libpq-misc">
  <title>Miscellaneous Functions</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5035

5036 5037 5038
  <para>
   As always, there are some functions that just don't fit anywhere.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5039

5040
  <variablelist>
5041
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfreemem">
5042 5043 5044 5045 5046 5047 5048 5049 5050 5051
    <term>
     <function>PQfreemem</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQfreemem</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Frees memory allocated by <application>libpq</>.
5052 5053 5054
<synopsis>
void PQfreemem(void *ptr);
</synopsis>
5055 5056 5057 5058 5059 5060 5061 5062 5063 5064 5065 5066 5067 5068 5069 5070 5071 5072 5073
     </para>

     <para>
      Frees memory allocated by <application>libpq</>, particularly
      <function>PQescapeByteaConn</function>,
      <function>PQescapeBytea</function>,
      <function>PQunescapeBytea</function>,
      and <function>PQnotifies</function>.
      It is particularly important that this function, rather than
      <function>free()</>, be used on Microsoft Windows.  This is because
      allocating memory in a DLL and releasing it in the application works
      only if multithreaded/single-threaded, release/debug, and static/dynamic
      flags are the same for the DLL and the application.  On non-Microsoft
      Windows platforms, this function is the same as the standard library
      function <function>free()</>.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5074
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqconninfofree">
5075 5076 5077 5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085
    <term>
     <function>PQconninfoFree</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQconninfoFree</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Frees the data structures allocated by
      <function>PQconndefaults</> or <function>PQconninfoParse</>.
5086 5087 5088
<synopsis>
void PQconninfoFree(PQconninfoOption *connOptions);
</synopsis>
5089 5090 5091 5092 5093 5094 5095 5096 5097
     </para>

     <para>
      A simple <function>PQfreemem</function> will not do for this, since
      the array contains references to subsidiary strings.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5098
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqencryptpassword">
5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108
    <term>
     <function>PQencryptPassword</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQencryptPassword</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Prepares the encrypted form of a <productname>PostgreSQL</> password.
5109 5110 5111
<synopsis>
char * PQencryptPassword(const char *passwd, const char *user);
</synopsis>
5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125 5126
      This function is intended to be used by client applications that
      wish to send commands like <literal>ALTER USER joe PASSWORD
      'pwd'</>.  It is good practice not to send the original cleartext
      password in such a command, because it might be exposed in command
      logs, activity displays, and so on.  Instead, use this function to
      convert the password to encrypted form before it is sent.  The
      arguments are the cleartext password, and the SQL name of the user
      it is for.  The return value is a string allocated by
      <function>malloc</function>, or <symbol>NULL</symbol> if out of
      memory.  The caller can assume the string doesn't contain any
      special characters that would require escaping.  Use
      <function>PQfreemem</> to free the result when done with it.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>
5127

5128
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqmakeemptypgresult">
5129 5130 5131 5132 5133 5134 5135 5136 5137 5138
    <term>
     <function>PQmakeEmptyPGresult</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQmakeEmptyPGresult</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Constructs an empty <structname>PGresult</structname> object with the given status.
5139 5140 5141
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQmakeEmptyPGresult(PGconn *conn, ExecStatusType status);
</synopsis>
5142 5143 5144 5145 5146
     </para>

     <para>
      This is <application>libpq</>'s internal function to allocate and
      initialize an empty <structname>PGresult</structname> object.  This
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5147
      function returns <symbol>NULL</> if memory could not be allocated. It is
5148 5149 5150 5151 5152
      exported because some applications find it useful to generate result
      objects (particularly objects with error status) themselves.  If
      <parameter>conn</parameter> is not null and <parameter>status</>
      indicates an error, the current error message of the specified
      connection is copied into the <structname>PGresult</structname>.
5153
      Also, if <parameter>conn</parameter> is not null, any event procedures
5154
      registered in the connection are copied into the
5155 5156 5157
      <structname>PGresult</structname>.  (They do not get
      <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</> calls, but see
      <function>PQfireResultCreateEvents</function>.)
5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164
      Note that <function>PQclear</function> should eventually be called
      on the object, just as with a <structname>PGresult</structname>
      returned by <application>libpq</application> itself.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5165
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqfireresultcreateevents">
5166 5167 5168 5169 5170 5171 5172 5173 5174 5175 5176 5177 5178
    <term>
     <function>PQfireResultCreateEvents</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQfireResultCreateEvents</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      Fires a <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</literal> event (see <xref
      linkend="libpq-events">) for each event procedure registered in the
      <structname>PGresult</structname> object.  Returns non-zero for success,
      zero if any event procedure fails.

5179 5180 5181
<synopsis>
int PQfireResultCreateEvents(PGconn *conn, PGresult *res);
</synopsis>
5182 5183 5184 5185
     </para>

     <para>
      The <literal>conn</> argument is passed through to event procedures
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5186
      but not used directly.  It can be <symbol>NULL</> if the event
5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200 5201 5202 5203 5204
      procedures won't use it.
     </para>

     <para>
      Event procedures that have already received a
      <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</> or <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCOPY</> event
      for this object are not fired again.
     </para>

     <para>
      The main reason that this function is separate from
      <function>PQmakeEmptyPGResult</function> is that it is often appropriate
      to create a <structname>PGresult</structname> and fill it with data
      before invoking the event procedures.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5205
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqcopyresult">
5206 5207 5208 5209 5210 5211 5212 5213 5214 5215 5216 5217
    <term>
     <function>PQcopyResult</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQcopyResult</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Makes a copy of a <structname>PGresult</structname> object.  The copy is
      not linked to the source result in any way and
      <function>PQclear</function> must be called when the copy is no longer
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5218
      needed.  If the function fails, <symbol>NULL</> is returned.
5219

5220 5221 5222
<synopsis>
PGresult *PQcopyResult(const PGresult *src, int flags);
</synopsis>
5223 5224 5225 5226 5227 5228 5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241 5242 5243
     </para>

     <para>
      This is not intended to make an exact copy.  The returned result is
      always put into <literal>PGRES_TUPLES_OK</literal> status, and does not
      copy any error message in the source.  (It does copy the command status
      string, however.)  The <parameter>flags</parameter> argument determines
      what else is copied.  It is a bitwise OR of several flags.
      <literal>PG_COPYRES_ATTRS</literal> specifies copying the source
      result's attributes (column definitions).
      <literal>PG_COPYRES_TUPLES</literal> specifies copying the source
      result's tuples.  (This implies copying the attributes, too.)
      <literal>PG_COPYRES_NOTICEHOOKS</literal> specifies
      copying the source result's notify hooks.
      <literal>PG_COPYRES_EVENTS</literal> specifies copying the source
      result's events.  (But any instance data associated with the source
      is not copied.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5244
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetresultattrs">
5245 5246 5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254
    <term>
     <function>PQsetResultAttrs</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQsetResultAttrs</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Sets the attributes of a <structname>PGresult</structname> object.
5255 5256 5257
<synopsis>
int PQsetResultAttrs(PGresult *res, int numAttributes, PGresAttDesc *attDescs);
</synopsis>
5258 5259 5260 5261
     </para>

     <para>
      The provided <parameter>attDescs</parameter> are copied into the result.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5262
      If the <parameter>attDescs</parameter> pointer is <symbol>NULL</> or
5263 5264 5265 5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271
      <parameter>numAttributes</parameter> is less than one, the request is
      ignored and the function succeeds.  If <parameter>res</parameter>
      already contains attributes, the function will fail.  If the function
      fails, the return value is zero.  If the function succeeds, the return
      value is non-zero.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5272
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetvalue">
5273 5274 5275 5276 5277 5278 5279 5280 5281 5282
    <term>
     <function>PQsetvalue</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQsetvalue</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Sets a tuple field value of a <structname>PGresult</structname> object.
5283 5284 5285
<synopsis>
int PQsetvalue(PGresult *res, int tup_num, int field_num, char *value, int len);
</synopsis>
5286 5287 5288 5289 5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295
     </para>

     <para>
      The function will automatically grow the result's internal tuples array
      as needed.  However, the <parameter>tup_num</parameter> argument must be
      less than or equal to <function>PQntuples</function>, meaning this
      function can only grow the tuples array one tuple at a time.  But any
      field of any existing tuple can be modified in any order.  If a value at
      <parameter>field_num</parameter> already exists, it will be overwritten.
      If <parameter>len</parameter> is <literal>-1</literal> or
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5296 5297
      <parameter>value</parameter> is <symbol>NULL</>, the field value
      will be set to an SQL null value.  The
5298 5299 5300 5301 5302 5303 5304 5305
      <parameter>value</parameter> is copied into the result's private storage,
      thus is no longer needed after the function
      returns.  If the function fails, the return value is zero.  If the
      function succeeds, the return value is non-zero.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5306
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresultalloc">
5307 5308 5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316
    <term>
     <function>PQresultAlloc</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQresultAlloc</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      Allocate subsidiary storage for a <structname>PGresult</structname> object.
5317 5318 5319
<synopsis>
void *PQresultAlloc(PGresult *res, size_t nBytes);
</synopsis>
5320 5321 5322 5323 5324
     </para>

     <para>
      Any memory allocated with this function will be freed when
      <parameter>res</parameter> is cleared.  If the function fails,
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5325
      the return value is <symbol>NULL</>.  The result is
5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331
      guaranteed to be adequately aligned for any type of data,
      just as for <function>malloc</>.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>

5332
  </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5333

5334
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5335

5336 5337
 <sect1 id="libpq-notice-processing">
  <title>Notice Processing</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5338

5339 5340 5341 5342
  <indexterm zone="libpq-notice-processing">
   <primary>notice processing</primary>
   <secondary>in libpq</secondary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5343

5344 5345 5346 5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352
  <para>
   Notice and warning messages generated by the server are not returned
   by the query execution functions, since they do not imply failure of
   the query.  Instead they are passed to a notice handling function, and
   execution continues normally after the handler returns.  The default
   notice handling function prints the message on
   <filename>stderr</filename>, but the application can override this
   behavior by supplying its own handling function.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5353

5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359 5360 5361
  <para>
   For historical reasons, there are two levels of notice handling, called
   the notice receiver and notice processor.  The default behavior is for
   the notice receiver to format the notice and pass a string to the notice
   processor for printing.  However, an application that chooses to provide
   its own notice receiver will typically ignore the notice processor
   layer and just do all the work in the notice receiver.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5362

5363 5364 5365 5366 5367 5368 5369 5370 5371
  <para>
   The function <function>PQsetNoticeReceiver</function>
   <indexterm><primary>notice
   receiver</></><indexterm><primary>PQsetNoticeReceiver</></> sets or
   examines the current notice receiver for a connection object.
   Similarly, <function>PQsetNoticeProcessor</function>
   <indexterm><primary>notice
   processor</></><indexterm><primary>PQsetNoticeProcessor</></> sets or
   examines the current notice processor.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5372

5373 5374
<synopsis>
typedef void (*PQnoticeReceiver) (void *arg, const PGresult *res);
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5375

5376 5377 5378 5379
PQnoticeReceiver
PQsetNoticeReceiver(PGconn *conn,
                    PQnoticeReceiver proc,
                    void *arg);
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5380

5381
typedef void (*PQnoticeProcessor) (void *arg, const char *message);
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5382

5383 5384 5385 5386 5387
PQnoticeProcessor
PQsetNoticeProcessor(PGconn *conn,
                     PQnoticeProcessor proc,
                     void *arg);
</synopsis>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5388

5389 5390 5391 5392 5393
   Each of these functions returns the previous notice receiver or
   processor function pointer, and sets the new value.  If you supply a
   null function pointer, no action is taken, but the current pointer is
   returned.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5394

5395 5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406
  <para>
   When a notice or warning message is received from the server, or
   generated internally by <application>libpq</application>, the notice
   receiver function is called.  It is passed the message in the form of
   a <symbol>PGRES_NONFATAL_ERROR</symbol>
   <structname>PGresult</structname>.  (This allows the receiver to extract
   individual fields using <function>PQresultErrorField</>, or the complete
   preformatted message using <function>PQresultErrorMessage</>.) The same
   void pointer passed to <function>PQsetNoticeReceiver</function> is also
   passed.  (This pointer can be used to access application-specific state
   if needed.)
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5407

5408 5409 5410 5411 5412
  <para>
   The default notice receiver simply extracts the message (using
   <function>PQresultErrorMessage</>) and passes it to the notice
   processor.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5413

5414 5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420
  <para>
   The notice processor is responsible for handling a notice or warning
   message given in text form.  It is passed the string text of the message
   (including a trailing newline), plus a void pointer that is the same
   one passed to <function>PQsetNoticeProcessor</function>.  (This pointer
   can be used to access application-specific state if needed.)
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5421

5422 5423
  <para>
   The default notice processor is simply:
5424
<programlisting>
5425 5426 5427 5428 5429 5430 5431
static void
defaultNoticeProcessor(void *arg, const char *message)
{
    fprintf(stderr, "%s", message);
}
</programlisting>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5432

5433 5434 5435 5436 5437 5438 5439 5440 5441
  <para>
   Once you have set a notice receiver or processor, you should expect
   that that function could be called as long as either the
   <structname>PGconn</> object or <structname>PGresult</> objects made
   from it exist.  At creation of a <structname>PGresult</>, the
   <structname>PGconn</>'s current notice handling pointers are copied
   into the <structname>PGresult</> for possible use by functions like
   <function>PQgetvalue</function>.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5442

5443
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
5444

5445 5446 5447 5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453 5454 5455 5456 5457 5458 5459 5460 5461 5462 5463 5464 5465 5466 5467
 <sect1 id="libpq-events">
  <title>Event System</title>

  <para>
   <application>libpq</application>'s event system is designed to notify
   registered event handlers about interesting
   <application>libpq</application> events, such as the creation or
   destruction of <structname>PGconn</structname> and
   <structname>PGresult</structname> objects.  A principal use case is that
   this allows applications to associate their own data with a
   <structname>PGconn</structname> or <structname>PGresult</structname>
   and ensure that that data is freed at an appropriate time.
  </para>

  <para>
   Each registered event handler is associated with two pieces of data,
   known to <application>libpq</application> only as opaque <literal>void *</>
   pointers.  There is a <firstterm>passthrough</> pointer that is provided
   by the application when the event handler is registered with a
   <structname>PGconn</>.  The passthrough pointer never changes for the
   life of the <structname>PGconn</> and all <structname>PGresult</>s
   generated from it; so if used, it must point to long-lived data.
   In addition there is an <firstterm>instance data</> pointer, which starts
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5468
   out <symbol>NULL</> in every <structname>PGconn</> and <structname>PGresult</>.
5469 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485 5486 5487 5488 5489 5490 5491 5492
   This pointer can be manipulated using the
   <function>PQinstanceData</function>,
   <function>PQsetInstanceData</function>,
   <function>PQresultInstanceData</function> and
   <function>PQsetResultInstanceData</function> functions.  Note that
   unlike the passthrough pointer, instance data of a <structname>PGconn</>
   is not automatically inherited by <structname>PGresult</>s created from
   it.  <application>libpq</application> does not know what passthrough
   and instance data pointers point to (if anything) and will never attempt
   to free them &mdash; that is the responsibility of the event handler.
  </para>

  <sect2 id="libpq-events-types">
   <title>Event Types</title>

   <para>
    The enum <literal>PGEventId</> names the types of events handled by
    the event system.  All its values have names beginning with
    <literal>PGEVT</literal>.  For each event type, there is a corresponding
    event info structure that carries the parameters passed to the event
    handlers.  The event types are:
   </para>

   <variablelist>
5493
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-register">
5494 5495 5496 5497 5498 5499 5500 5501 5502
     <term><literal>PGEVT_REGISTER</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The register event occurs when <function>PQregisterEventProc</function>
       is called.  It is the ideal time to initialize any
       <literal>instanceData</literal> an event procedure may need.  Only one
       register event will be fired per event handler per connection.  If the
       event procedure fails, the registration is aborted.

5503
<synopsis>
5504 5505
typedef struct
{
5506
    PGconn *conn;
5507
} PGEventRegister;
5508
</synopsis>
5509 5510 5511 5512 5513 5514 5515

       When a <literal>PGEVT_REGISTER</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventRegister *</structname>.  This structure contains a
       <structname>PGconn</structname> that should be in the
       <literal>CONNECTION_OK</literal> status; guaranteed if one calls
       <function>PQregisterEventProc</function> right after obtaining a good
5516 5517 5518
       <structname>PGconn</structname>.  When returning a failure code, all
       cleanup must be performed as no <literal>PGEVT_CONNDESTROY</literal>
       event will be sent.
5519 5520 5521 5522
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5523
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-connreset">
5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535
     <term><literal>PGEVT_CONNRESET</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The connection reset event is fired on completion of
       <function>PQreset</function> or <function>PQresetPoll</function>.  In
       both cases, the event is only fired if the reset was successful.  If
       the event procedure fails, the entire connection reset will fail; the
       <structname>PGconn</structname> is put into
       <literal>CONNECTION_BAD</literal> status and
       <function>PQresetPoll</function> will return
       <literal>PGRES_POLLING_FAILED</literal>.

5536
<synopsis>
5537 5538
typedef struct
{
5539
    PGconn *conn;
5540
} PGEventConnReset;
5541
</synopsis>
5542 5543 5544 5545 5546 5547

       When a <literal>PGEVT_CONNRESET</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventConnReset *</structname>.  Although the contained
       <structname>PGconn</structname> was just reset, all event data remains
       unchanged.  This event should be used to reset/reload/requery any
5548 5549 5550 5551
       associated <literal>instanceData</literal>.  Note that even if the
       event procedure fails to process <literal>PGEVT_CONNRESET</>, it will
       still receive a <literal>PGEVT_CONNDESTROY</> event when the connection
       is closed.
5552 5553 5554 5555
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5556
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-conndestroy">
5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562 5563 5564 5565
     <term><literal>PGEVT_CONNDESTROY</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The connection destroy event is fired in response to
       <function>PQfinish</function>.  It is the event procedure's
       responsibility to properly clean up its event data as libpq has no
       ability to manage this memory.  Failure to clean up will lead
       to memory leaks.

5566
<synopsis>
5567 5568
typedef struct
{
5569
    PGconn *conn;
5570
} PGEventConnDestroy;
5571
</synopsis>
5572 5573 5574 5575 5576 5577 5578 5579 5580 5581 5582 5583 5584

       When a <literal>PGEVT_CONNDESTROY</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventConnDestroy *</structname>.  This event is fired
       prior to <function>PQfinish</function> performing any other cleanup.
       The return value of the event procedure is ignored since there is no
       way of indicating a failure from <function>PQfinish</function>.  Also,
       an event procedure failure should not abort the process of cleaning up
       unwanted memory.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5585
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-resultcreate">
5586 5587 5588 5589 5590 5591 5592 5593
     <term><literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The result creation event is fired in response to any query execution
       function that generates a result, including
       <function>PQgetResult</function>.  This event will only be fired after
       the result has been created successfully.

5594
<synopsis>
5595 5596
typedef struct
{
5597
    PGconn *conn;
5598 5599
    PGresult *result;
} PGEventResultCreate;
5600
</synopsis>
5601 5602 5603 5604 5605 5606 5607 5608 5609

       When a <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventResultCreate *</structname>.  The
       <parameter>conn</parameter> is the connection used to generate the
       result.  This is the ideal place to initialize any
       <literal>instanceData</literal> that needs to be associated with the
       result.  If the event procedure fails, the result will be cleared and
       the failure will be propagated.  The event procedure must not try to
5610 5611 5612
       <function>PQclear</> the result object for itself.  When returning a
       failure code, all cleanup must be performed as no
       <literal>PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY</literal> event will be sent.
5613 5614 5615 5616
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5617
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-resultcopy">
5618 5619 5620 5621 5622
     <term><literal>PGEVT_RESULTCOPY</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The result copy event is fired in response to
       <function>PQcopyResult</function>.  This event will only be fired after
5623 5624 5625 5626
       the copy is complete.  Only event procedures that have
       successfully handled the <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCREATE</literal>
       or <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCOPY</literal> event for the source result
       will receive <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCOPY</literal> events.
5627

5628
<synopsis>
5629 5630 5631 5632 5633
typedef struct
{
    const PGresult *src;
    PGresult *dest;
} PGEventResultCopy;
5634
</synopsis>
5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642 5643

       When a <literal>PGEVT_RESULTCOPY</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventResultCopy *</structname>.  The
       <parameter>src</parameter> result is what was copied while the
       <parameter>dest</parameter> result is the copy destination.  This event
       can be used to provide a deep copy of <literal>instanceData</literal>,
       since <literal>PQcopyResult</literal> cannot do that.  If the event
       procedure fails, the entire copy operation will fail and the
5644 5645 5646 5647
       <parameter>dest</parameter> result will be cleared.   When returning a
       failure code, all cleanup must be performed as no
       <literal>PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY</literal> event will be sent for the
       destination result.
5648 5649 5650 5651
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5652
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgevt-resultdestroy">
5653 5654 5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661
     <term><literal>PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY</literal></term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
       The result destroy event is fired in response to a
       <function>PQclear</function>.  It is the event procedure's
       responsibility to properly clean up its event data as libpq has no
       ability to manage this memory.  Failure to clean up will lead
       to memory leaks.

5662
<synopsis>
5663 5664
typedef struct
{
5665
    PGresult *result;
5666
} PGEventResultDestroy;
5667
</synopsis>
5668 5669 5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686

       When a <literal>PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY</literal> event is received, the
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer should be cast to a
       <structname>PGEventResultDestroy *</structname>.  This event is fired
       prior to <function>PQclear</function> performing any other cleanup.
       The return value of the event procedure is ignored since there is no
       way of indicating a failure from <function>PQclear</function>.  Also,
       an event procedure failure should not abort the process of cleaning up
       unwanted memory.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </sect2>

  <sect2 id="libpq-events-proc">
   <title>Event Callback Procedure</title>

   <variablelist>
5687
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pgeventproc">
5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700
     <term>
      <literal>PGEventProc</literal>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PGEventProc</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       <literal>PGEventProc</literal> is a typedef for a pointer to an
       event procedure, that is, the user callback function that receives
       events from libpq.  The signature of an event procedure must be

5701
<synopsis>
5702
int eventproc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough)
5703
</synopsis>
5704 5705 5706 5707 5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717 5718 5719

       The <parameter>evtId</parameter> parameter indicates which
       <literal>PGEVT</literal> event occurred.  The
       <parameter>evtInfo</parameter> pointer must be cast to the appropriate
       structure type to obtain further information about the event.
       The <parameter>passThrough</parameter> parameter is the pointer
       provided to <function>PQregisterEventProc</function> when the event
       procedure was registered.  The function should return a non-zero value
       if it succeeds and zero if it fails.
      </para>

      <para>
       A particular event procedure can be registered only once in any
       <structname>PGconn</>.  This is because the address of the procedure
       is used as a lookup key to identify the associated instance data.
      </para>
5720 5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 5727 5728 5729 5730 5731 5732

      <caution>
       <para>
        On Windows, functions can have two different addresses: one visible
        from outside a DLL and another visible from inside the DLL.  One
        should be careful that only one of these addresses is used with
        <application>libpq</>'s event-procedure functions, else confusion will
        result.  The simplest rule for writing code that will work is to
        ensure that event procedures are declared <literal>static</>.  If the
        procedure's address must be available outside its own source file,
        expose a separate function to return the address.
       </para>
      </caution>
5733 5734 5735 5736 5737 5738 5739 5740 5741
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </sect2>

  <sect2 id="libpq-events-funcs">
   <title>Event Support Functions</title>

    <variablelist>
5742
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqregistereventproc">
5743 5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753
     <term>
      <function>PQregisterEventProc</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQregisterEventProc</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Registers an event callback procedure with libpq.

5754 5755 5756 5757
<synopsis>
int PQregisterEventProc(PGconn *conn, PGEventProc proc,
                        const char *name, void *passThrough);
</synopsis>
5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763 5764 5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772
      </para>

      <para>
       An event procedure must be registered once on each
       <structname>PGconn</> you want to receive events about.  There is no
       limit, other than memory, on the number of event procedures that
       can be registered with a connection.  The function returns a non-zero
       value if it succeeds and zero if it fails.
      </para>

      <para>
       The <parameter>proc</parameter> argument will be called when a libpq
       event is fired.  Its memory address is also used to lookup
       <literal>instanceData</literal>.  The <parameter>name</parameter>
       argument is used to refer to the event procedure in error messages.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5773
       This value cannot be <symbol>NULL</> or a zero-length string.  The name string is
5774 5775 5776
       copied into the <structname>PGconn</>, so what is passed need not be
       long-lived.  The <parameter>passThrough</parameter> pointer is passed
       to the <parameter>proc</parameter> whenever an event occurs. This
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5777
       argument can be <symbol>NULL</>.
5778 5779 5780 5781
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5782
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqsetinstancedata">
5783 5784 5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790
     <term>
      <function>PQsetInstanceData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQsetInstanceData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5791 5792 5793 5794 5795
       Sets the connection <parameter>conn</>'s <literal>instanceData</>
       for procedure <parameter>proc</> to <parameter>data</>.  This
       returns non-zero for success and zero for failure.  (Failure is
       only possible if <parameter>proc</> has not been properly
       registered in <parameter>conn</>.)
5796

5797 5798 5799
<synopsis>
int PQsetInstanceData(PGconn *conn, PGEventProc proc, void *data);
</synopsis>
5800 5801 5802 5803
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5804
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqinstancedata">
5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812
     <term>
      <function>PQinstanceData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQinstanceData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5813 5814 5815 5816
       Returns the
       connection <parameter>conn</>'s <literal>instanceData</literal>
       associated with procedure <parameter>proc</>,
       or <symbol>NULL</symbol> if there is none.
5817

5818 5819 5820
<synopsis>
void *PQinstanceData(const PGconn *conn, PGEventProc proc);
</synopsis>
5821 5822 5823 5824
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5825
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresultsetinstancedata">
5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832 5833
     <term>
      <function>PQresultSetInstanceData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQresultSetInstanceData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5834 5835 5836 5837 5838
       Sets the result's <literal>instanceData</>
       for <parameter>proc</> to <parameter>data</>.  This returns
       non-zero for success and zero for failure.  (Failure is only
       possible if <parameter>proc</> has not been properly registered
       in the result.)
5839

5840 5841 5842
<synopsis>
int PQresultSetInstanceData(PGresult *res, PGEventProc proc, void *data);
</synopsis>
5843 5844 5845 5846
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

5847
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqresultinstancedata">
5848 5849 5850 5851 5852 5853 5854 5855
     <term>
      <function>PQresultInstanceData</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQresultInstanceData</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>
     <listitem>
      <para>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
5856
       Returns the result's <literal>instanceData</> associated with <parameter>proc</>, or <symbol>NULL</>
5857 5858
       if there is none.

5859 5860 5861
<synopsis>
void *PQresultInstanceData(const PGresult *res, PGEventProc proc);
</synopsis>
5862 5863 5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873 5874 5875
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </sect2>

  <sect2 id="libpq-events-example">
   <title>Event Example</title>

   <para>
    Here is a skeleton example of managing private data associated with
    libpq connections and results.
   </para>

5876
<programlisting>
5877
<![CDATA[
5878
/* required header for libpq events (note: includes libpq-fe.h) */
5879
#include <libpq-events.h>
5880 5881 5882 5883 5884 5885 5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900 5901 5902 5903 5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910 5911 5912 5913 5914 5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926 5927 5928 5929 5930 5931 5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937 5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943 5944 5945 5946 5947 5948 5949 5950

/* The instanceData */
typedef struct
{
    int n;
    char *str;
} mydata;

/* PGEventProc */
static int myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough);

int
main(void)
{
    mydata *data;
    PGresult *res;
    PGconn *conn = PQconnectdb("dbname = postgres");

    if (PQstatus(conn) != CONNECTION_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "Connection to database failed: %s",
                PQerrorMessage(conn));
        PQfinish(conn);
        return 1;
    }

    /* called once on any connection that should receive events.
     * Sends a PGEVT_REGISTER to myEventProc.
     */
    if (!PQregisterEventProc(conn, myEventProc, "mydata_proc", NULL))
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "Cannot register PGEventProc\n");
        PQfinish(conn);
        return 1;
    }

    /* conn instanceData is available */
    data = PQinstanceData(conn, myEventProc);

    /* Sends a PGEVT_RESULTCREATE to myEventProc */
    res = PQexec(conn, "SELECT 1 + 1");

    /* result instanceData is available */
    data = PQresultInstanceData(res, myEventProc);

    /* If PG_COPYRES_EVENTS is used, sends a PGEVT_RESULTCOPY to myEventProc */
    res_copy = PQcopyResult(res, PG_COPYRES_TUPLES | PG_COPYRES_EVENTS);

    /* result instanceData is available if PG_COPYRES_EVENTS was
     * used during the PQcopyResult call.
     */
    data = PQresultInstanceData(res_copy, myEventProc);

    /* Both clears send a PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY to myEventProc */
    PQclear(res);
    PQclear(res_copy);

    /* Sends a PGEVT_CONNDESTROY to myEventProc */
    PQfinish(conn);

    return 0;
}

static int
myEventProc(PGEventId evtId, void *evtInfo, void *passThrough)
{
    switch (evtId)
    {
        case PGEVT_REGISTER:
        {
            PGEventRegister *e = (PGEventRegister *)evtInfo;
5951
            mydata *data = get_mydata(e->conn);
5952 5953

            /* associate app specific data with connection */
5954
            PQsetInstanceData(e->conn, myEventProc, data);
5955 5956 5957 5958 5959 5960
            break;
        }

        case PGEVT_CONNRESET:
        {
            PGEventConnReset *e = (PGEventConnReset *)evtInfo;
5961
            mydata *data = PQinstanceData(e->conn, myEventProc);
5962 5963 5964 5965 5966 5967 5968 5969 5970

            if (data)
              memset(data, 0, sizeof(mydata));
            break;
        }

        case PGEVT_CONNDESTROY:
        {
            PGEventConnDestroy *e = (PGEventConnDestroy *)evtInfo;
5971
            mydata *data = PQinstanceData(e->conn, myEventProc);
5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978 5979 5980 5981

            /* free instance data because the conn is being destroyed */
            if (data)
              free_mydata(data);
            break;
        }

        case PGEVT_RESULTCREATE:
        {
            PGEventResultCreate *e = (PGEventResultCreate *)evtInfo;
5982
            mydata *conn_data = PQinstanceData(e->conn, myEventProc);
5983 5984 5985
            mydata *res_data = dup_mydata(conn_data);

            /* associate app specific data with result (copy it from conn) */
5986
            PQsetResultInstanceData(e->result, myEventProc, res_data);
5987 5988 5989 5990 5991 5992
            break;
        }

        case PGEVT_RESULTCOPY:
        {
            PGEventResultCopy *e = (PGEventResultCopy *)evtInfo;
5993
            mydata *src_data = PQresultInstanceData(e->src, myEventProc);
5994 5995 5996
            mydata *dest_data = dup_mydata(src_data);

            /* associate app specific data with result (copy it from a result) */
5997
            PQsetResultInstanceData(e->dest, myEventProc, dest_data);
5998 5999 6000 6001 6002 6003
            break;
        }

        case PGEVT_RESULTDESTROY:
        {
            PGEventResultDestroy *e = (PGEventResultDestroy *)evtInfo;
6004
            mydata *data = PQresultInstanceData(e->result, myEventProc);
6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018

            /* free instance data because the result is being destroyed */
            if (data)
              free_mydata(data);
            break;
        }

        /* unknown event id, just return TRUE. */
        default:
            break;
    }

    return TRUE; /* event processing succeeded */
}
6019
]]>
6020 6021 6022 6023
</programlisting>
  </sect2>
 </sect1>

6024 6025
 <sect1 id="libpq-envars">
  <title>Environment Variables</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6026

6027 6028 6029
  <indexterm zone="libpq-envars">
   <primary>environment variable</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6030

6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037
  <para>
   The following environment variables can be used to select default
   connection parameter values, which will be used by
   <function>PQconnectdb</>, <function>PQsetdbLogin</> and
   <function>PQsetdb</> if no value is directly specified by the calling
   code.  These are useful to avoid hard-coding database connection
   information into simple client applications, for example.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6038

6039 6040 6041 6042 6043 6044
   <itemizedlist>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGHOST</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6045
      <envar>PGHOST</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6046
      linkend="libpq-connect-host"> connection parameter.
6047 6048 6049 6050 6051 6052 6053 6054
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGHOSTADDR</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6055
      <envar>PGHOSTADDR</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6056 6057 6058
      linkend="libpq-connect-hostaddr"> connection parameter.
      This can be set instead of or in addition to <envar>PGHOST</envar>
      to avoid DNS lookup overhead.
6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGPORT</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6067
      <envar>PGPORT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6068
      linkend="libpq-connect-port"> connection parameter.
6069 6070 6071 6072 6073
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6074
      <indexterm>
6075 6076
       <primary><envar>PGDATABASE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6077
      <envar>PGDATABASE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6078 6079
      linkend="libpq-connect-dbname"> connection parameter.
      </para>
6080 6081 6082 6083 6084 6085 6086
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGUSER</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6087
      <envar>PGUSER</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6088
      linkend="libpq-connect-user"> connection parameter.
6089 6090 6091 6092
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6093
     <para>
6094 6095 6096
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGPASSWORD</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6097
      <envar>PGPASSWORD</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6098 6099
      linkend="libpq-connect-password"> connection parameter.
      Use of this environment variable
6100
      is not recommended for security reasons, as some operating systems
6101
      allow non-root users to see process environment variables via
6102
      <application>ps</>; instead consider using the
6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109 6110 6111 6112 6113 6114 6115 6116
      <filename>~/.pgpass</> file (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">).
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGPASSFILE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGPASSFILE</envar> specifies the name of the password file to
      use for lookups.  If not set, it defaults to <filename>~/.pgpass</>
      (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgpass">).
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6117

6118 6119 6120 6121 6122
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSERVICE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6123
      <envar>PGSERVICE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6124
      linkend="libpq-connect-service"> connection parameter.
6125 6126
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6127

6128 6129 6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135 6136 6137 6138 6139
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSERVICEFILE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGSERVICEFILE</envar> specifies the name of the per-user
      connection service file.  If not set, it defaults
      to <filename>~/.pg_service.conf</>
      (see <xref linkend="libpq-pgservice">).
     </para>
    </listitem>

6140 6141 6142 6143 6144
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGREALM</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6145
      <envar>PGREALM</envar> sets the Kerberos realm to use with
6146 6147
      <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, if  it is different from the
      local realm.  If <envar>PGREALM</envar> is set,
6148
      <application>libpq</application> applications will attempt
6149
      authentication  with  servers for this realm and use separate ticket
6150
      files to avoid conflicts with local ticket files.   This
6151 6152 6153 6154
      environment  variable is only used if Kerberos authentication is
      selected by the server.
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6155

6156 6157 6158 6159 6160
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGOPTIONS</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6161
      <envar>PGOPTIONS</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6162
      linkend="libpq-connect-options"> connection parameter.
6163 6164
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6165

6166 6167 6168 6169 6170 6171 6172 6173 6174 6175
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGAPPNAME</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGAPPNAME</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
      linkend="libpq-connect-application-name"> connection parameter.
     </para>
    </listitem>

6176 6177 6178 6179 6180
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSSLMODE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6181
      <envar>PGSSLMODE</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6182
      linkend="libpq-connect-sslmode"> connection parameter.
6183 6184
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6185

6186 6187 6188 6189 6190
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGREQUIRESSL</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6191
      <envar>PGREQUIRESSL</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6192
      linkend="libpq-connect-requiressl"> connection parameter.
6193 6194
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6195

6196 6197 6198 6199 6200
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSSLCERT</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6201
      <envar>PGSSLCERT</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6202
      linkend="libpq-connect-sslcert"> connection parameter.
6203 6204 6205
     </para>
    </listitem>

6206 6207 6208 6209 6210
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSSLKEY</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6211
      <envar>PGSSLKEY</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6212
      linkend="libpq-connect-sslkey"> connection parameter.
6213 6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSSLROOTCERT</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6221
      <envar>PGSSLROOTCERT</envar>  behaves the same as the <xref
6222
      linkend="libpq-connect-sslrootcert"> connection parameter.
6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230
     </para>
    </listitem>

    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSSLCRL</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6231
      <envar>PGSSLCRL</envar>  behaves the same as the <xref
6232
      linkend="libpq-connect-sslcrl"> connection parameter.
6233 6234
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6235

6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGREQUIREPEER</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGREQUIREPEER</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
      linkend="libpq-connect-requirepeer"> connection parameter.
     </para>
    </listitem>

6246 6247 6248 6249 6250
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGKRBSRVNAME</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6251
      <envar>PGKRBSRVNAME</envar>  behaves the same as the <xref
6252
      linkend="libpq-connect-krbsrvname"> connection parameter.
6253 6254
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6255

6256 6257 6258 6259 6260
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGGSSLIB</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6261
      <envar>PGGSSLIB</envar> behaves the same as the <xref
6262
      linkend="libpq-connect-gsslib"> connection parameter.
6263 6264
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6265

6266 6267 6268 6269 6270
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
6271
      <envar>PGCONNECT_TIMEOUT</envar>  behaves the same as the <xref
6272
      linkend="libpq-connect-connect-timeout"> connection parameter.
6273 6274 6275 6276
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </itemizedlist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6277

6278
  <para>
6279 6280
   The following environment variables can be used to specify default
   behavior for each <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> session.  (See
6281 6282
   also the <xref linkend="sql-alteruser">
   and <xref linkend="sql-alterdatabase">
6283 6284
   commands for ways to set default behavior on a per-user or per-database
   basis.)
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6285

6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296
   <itemizedlist>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGDATESTYLE</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGDATESTYLE</envar> sets the default style of date/time
      representation.  (Equivalent to <literal>SET datestyle TO
      ...</literal>.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
6297

6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGTZ</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGTZ</envar> sets the default time zone.  (Equivalent to
      <literal>SET timezone TO ...</literal>.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6307

6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGCLIENTENCODING</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGCLIENTENCODING</envar> sets the default client character
      set encoding.  (Equivalent to <literal>SET client_encoding TO
      ...</literal>.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6318

6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGGEQO</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGGEQO</envar> sets the default mode for the genetic query
      optimizer.  (Equivalent to <literal>SET geqo TO ...</literal>.)
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </itemizedlist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6329

6330 6331
   Refer to the <acronym>SQL</acronym> command <xref linkend="sql-set">
   for information on correct values for these
6332
   environment variables.
6333
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6334

6335
  <para>
6336 6337
   The following environment variables determine internal behavior of
   <application>libpq</application>; they override compiled-in defaults.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6338

6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345
   <itemizedlist>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGSYSCONFDIR</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGSYSCONFDIR</envar> sets the directory containing the
6346 6347
      <filename>pg_service.conf</> file and in a future version
      possibly other system-wide configuration files.
6348 6349
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6350

6351 6352 6353 6354 6355 6356 6357 6358 6359 6360
    <listitem>
     <para>
      <indexterm>
       <primary><envar>PGLOCALEDIR</envar></primary>
      </indexterm>
      <envar>PGLOCALEDIR</envar> sets the directory containing the
      <literal>locale</> files for message internationalization.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </itemizedlist>
6361
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6362

6363
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6364 6365


6366 6367
 <sect1 id="libpq-pgpass">
  <title>The Password File</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6368

6369 6370 6371 6372 6373 6374
  <indexterm zone="libpq-pgpass">
   <primary>password file</primary>
  </indexterm>
  <indexterm zone="libpq-pgpass">
   <primary>.pgpass</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6375

6376
  <para>
6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383
   The file <filename>.pgpass</filename> in a user's home directory or the
   file referenced by <envar>PGPASSFILE</envar> can contain passwords to
   be used if the connection requires a password (and no password has been
   specified  otherwise). On Microsoft Windows the file is named
   <filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\pgpass.conf</> (where
   <filename>%APPDATA%</> refers to the Application Data subdirectory in
   the user's profile).
6384
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6385

6386
  <para>
6387
   This file should contain lines of the following format:
6388 6389 6390
<synopsis>
<replaceable>hostname</replaceable>:<replaceable>port</replaceable>:<replaceable>database</replaceable>:<replaceable>username</replaceable>:<replaceable>password</replaceable>
</synopsis>
6391 6392 6393 6394 6395 6396
   Each of the first four fields can be a literal value, or
   <literal>*</literal>, which matches anything.  The password field from
   the first line that matches the current connection parameters will be
   used.  (Therefore, put more-specific entries first when you are using
   wildcards.) If an entry needs to contain <literal>:</literal> or
   <literal>\</literal>, escape this character with <literal>\</literal>.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6397
   A host name of <literal>localhost</> matches both TCP (host name
6398 6399
   <literal>localhost</>) and Unix domain socket (<literal>pghost</> empty
   or the default socket directory) connections coming from the local
6400 6401
   machine. In a standby server, a database name of <literal>replication</>
   matches streaming replication connections made to the master server.
6402 6403
   The <literal>database</> field is of limited usefulness because
   users have the same password for all databases in the same cluster.
6404
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6405

6406
  <para>
6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412
   On Unix systems, the permissions on <filename>.pgpass</filename> must
   disallow any access to world or group; achieve this by the command
   <command>chmod 0600 ~/.pgpass</command>.  If the permissions are less
   strict than this, the file will be ignored.  On Microsoft Windows, it
   is assumed that the file is stored in a directory that is secure, so
   no special permissions check is made.
6413
  </para>
6414
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6415 6416


6417 6418
 <sect1 id="libpq-pgservice">
  <title>The Connection Service File</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6419

6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425
  <indexterm zone="libpq-pgservice">
   <primary>connection service file</primary>
  </indexterm>
  <indexterm zone="libpq-pgservice">
   <primary>pg_service.conf</primary>
  </indexterm>
6426 6427 6428
  <indexterm zone="libpq-pgservice">
   <primary>.pg_service.conf</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6429

6430
  <para>
6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436
   The connection service file allows libpq connection parameters to be
   associated with a single service name. That service name can then be
   specified by a libpq connection, and the associated settings will be
   used. This allows connection parameters to be modified without requiring
   a recompile of the libpq application. The service name can also be
   specified using the <envar>PGSERVICE</envar> environment variable.
6437
  </para>
6438 6439

  <para>
6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449 6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464
   The connection service file can be a per-user service file
   at <filename>~/.pg_service.conf</filename> or the location
   specified by the environment variable <envar>PGSERVICEFILE</envar>,
   or it can be a system-wide file
   at <filename>etc/pg_service.conf</filename> or in the directory
   specified by the environment variable
   <envar>PGSYSCONFDIR</envar>.  If service definitions with the same
   name exist in the user and the system file, the user file takes
   precedence.
  </para>

  <para>
   The file uses an <quote>INI file</quote> format where the section
   name is the service name and the parameters are connection
   parameters; see <xref linkend="libpq-connect"> for a list.  For
   example:
<programlisting>
# comment
[mydb]
host=somehost
port=5433
user=admin
</programlisting>
   An example file is provided at
   <filename>share/pg_service.conf.sample</filename>.
6465 6466
  </para>
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6467 6468


6469 6470
 <sect1 id="libpq-ldap">
  <title>LDAP Lookup of Connection Parameters</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6471

6472 6473 6474
  <indexterm zone="libpq-ldap">
   <primary>LDAP connection parameter lookup</primary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6475

6476
  <para>
6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482
   If <application>libpq</application> has been compiled with LDAP support (option
   <literal><option>--with-ldap</option></literal> for <command>configure</command>)
   it is possible to retrieve connection options like <literal>host</literal>
   or <literal>dbname</literal> via LDAP from a central server.
   The advantage is that if the connection parameters for a database change,
   the connection information doesn't have to be updated on all client machines.
6483
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6484

6485
  <para>
6486 6487 6488 6489 6490 6491 6492 6493 6494
   LDAP connection parameter lookup uses the connection service file
   <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> (see <xref
   linkend="libpq-pgservice">).  A line in a
   <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> stanza that starts with
   <literal>ldap://</literal> will be recognized as an LDAP URL and an
   LDAP query will be performed. The result must be a list of
   <literal>keyword = value</literal> pairs which will be used to set
   connection options.  The URL must conform to RFC 1959 and be of the
   form
6495 6496 6497
<synopsis>
ldap://[<replaceable>hostname</replaceable>[:<replaceable>port</replaceable>]]/<replaceable>search_base</replaceable>?<replaceable>attribute</replaceable>?<replaceable>search_scope</replaceable>?<replaceable>filter</replaceable>
</synopsis>
6498 6499 6500
   where <replaceable>hostname</replaceable> defaults to
   <literal>localhost</literal> and <replaceable>port</replaceable>
   defaults to 389.
6501
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6502

6503
  <para>
6504 6505 6506 6507 6508 6509 6510
   Processing of <filename>pg_service.conf</filename> is terminated after
   a successful LDAP lookup, but is continued if the LDAP server cannot
   be contacted.  This is to provide a fallback with further LDAP URL
   lines that point to different LDAP servers, classical <literal>keyword
   = value</literal> pairs, or default connection options.  If you would
   rather get an error message in this case, add a syntactically incorrect
   line after the LDAP URL.
6511
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6512

6513 6514
  <para>
   A sample LDAP entry that has been created with the LDIF file
6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526 6527
<programlisting>
version:1
dn:cn=mydatabase,dc=mycompany,dc=com
changetype:add
objectclass:top
objectclass:groupOfUniqueNames
cn:mydatabase
uniqueMember:host=dbserver.mycompany.com
uniqueMember:port=5439
uniqueMember:dbname=mydb
uniqueMember:user=mydb_user
uniqueMember:sslmode=require
</programlisting>
6528
   might be queried with the following LDAP URL:
6529 6530 6531
<programlisting>
ldap://ldap.mycompany.com/dc=mycompany,dc=com?uniqueMember?one?(cn=mydatabase)
</programlisting>
6532
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6533 6534 6535 6536 6537

  <para>
   You can also mix regular service file entries with LDAP lookups.
   A complete example for a stanza in <filename>pg_service.conf</filename>
   would be:
6538 6539 6540 6541 6542 6543 6544
<programlisting>
# only host and port are stored in LDAP, specify dbname and user explicitly
[customerdb]
dbname=customer
user=appuser
ldap://ldap.acme.com/cn=dbserver,cn=hosts?pgconnectinfo?base?(objectclass=*)
</programlisting>
6545 6546
  </para>

6547
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6548 6549


6550 6551
 <sect1 id="libpq-ssl">
  <title>SSL Support</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6552

6553 6554
  <indexterm zone="libpq-ssl">
   <primary>SSL</primary>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6555
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6556

6557
  <para>
6558 6559 6560 6561
   <productname>PostgreSQL</> has native support for using <acronym>SSL</>
   connections to encrypt client/server communications for increased
   security. See <xref linkend="ssl-tcp"> for details about the server-side
   <acronym>SSL</> functionality.
6562
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6563

B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6564
  <para>
6565 6566 6567
   <application>libpq</application> reads the system-wide
   <productname>OpenSSL</productname> configuration file. By default, this
   file is named <filename>openssl.cnf</filename> and is located in the
6568 6569
   directory reported by <literal>openssl version -d</>.  This default
   can be overridden by setting environment variable
6570 6571
   <envar>OPENSSL_CONF</envar> to the name of the desired configuration
   file.
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6572
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6573

6574 6575 6576 6577
 <sect2 id="libq-ssl-certificates">
  <title>Certificate verification</title>

  <para>
6578
   By default, <productname>PostgreSQL</> will not perform any verification of
6579 6580
   the server certificate. This means that it is possible to spoof the server
   identity (for example by modifying a DNS record or by taking over the server
6581
   IP address) without the client knowing. In order to prevent spoofing,
6582
   <acronym>SSL</> certificate verification must be used.
6583 6584 6585
  </para>

  <para>
6586 6587 6588 6589
   If the parameter <literal>sslmode</> is set to <literal>verify-ca</>,
   libpq will verify that the server is trustworthy by checking the
   certificate chain up to a trusted certificate authority
   (<acronym>CA</>). If <literal>sslmode</> is set to <literal>verify-full</>,
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6590
   libpq will <emphasis>also</> verify that the server host name matches its
6591 6592 6593
   certificate. The SSL connection will fail if the server certificate cannot
   be verified. <literal>verify-full</> is recommended in most
   security-sensitive environments.
6594 6595
  </para>

6596
  <para>
6597
   In <literal>verify-full</> mode, the <literal>cn</> (Common Name) attribute
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6598
   of the certificate is matched against the host name. If the <literal>cn</>
6599 6600 6601
   attribute starts with an asterisk (<literal>*</>), it will be treated as
   a wildcard, and will match all characters <emphasis>except</> a dot
   (<literal>.</>). This means the certificate will not match subdomains.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6602
   If the connection is made using an IP address instead of a host name, the
6603 6604 6605 6606
   IP address will be matched (without doing any DNS lookups).
  </para>

  <para>
6607 6608
   To allow server certificate verification, the certificate(s) of one or more
   trusted <acronym>CA</>s must be
6609 6610
   placed in the file <filename>~/.postgresql/root.crt</> in the user's home
   directory. (On Microsoft Windows the file is named
6611
   <filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\root.crt</filename>.)
6612 6613 6614
  </para>

  <para>
6615
   Certificate Revocation List (CRL) entries are also checked
6616 6617 6618
   if the file <filename>~/.postgresql/root.crl</filename> exists
   (<filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\root.crl</filename> on Microsoft
   Windows).
6619 6620 6621
  </para>

  <para>
6622 6623 6624
   The location of the root certificate file and the CRL can be changed by
   setting
   the connection parameters <literal>sslrootcert</> and <literal>sslcrl</>
6625
   or the environment variables <envar>PGSSLROOTCERT</> and <envar>PGSSLCRL</>.
6626
  </para>
6627 6628 6629 6630
 </sect2>

 <sect2 id="libpq-ssl-clientcert">
  <title>Client certificates</title>
6631 6632 6633

  <para>
   If the server requests a trusted client certificate,
6634
   <application>libpq</application> will send the certificate stored in
6635 6636 6637 6638
   file <filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.crt</> in the user's home
   directory.  The certificate must be signed by one of the certificate
   authorities (<acronym>CA</acronym>) trusted by the server.  A matching
   private key file <filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.key</> must also
6639
   be present. The private
6640 6641 6642
   key file must not allow any access to world or group; achieve this by the
   command <command>chmod 0600 ~/.postgresql/postgresql.key</command>.
   On Microsoft Windows these files are named
6643
   <filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\postgresql.crt</filename> and
6644 6645
   <filename>%APPDATA%\postgresql\postgresql.key</filename>, and there
   is no special permissions check since the directory is presumed secure.
6646 6647 6648
   The location of the certificate and key files can be overridden by the
   connection parameters <literal>sslcert</> and <literal>sslkey</> or the
   environment variables <envar>PGSSLCERT</> and <envar>PGSSLKEY</>.
6649 6650
  </para>

6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657 6658 6659 6660 6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667 6668
  <para>
   In some cases, the client certificate might be signed by an
   <quote>intermediate</> certificate authority, rather than one that is
   directly trusted by the server.  To use such a certificate, append the
   certificate of the signing authority to the <filename>postgresql.crt</>
   file, then its parent authority's certificate, and so on up to a
   <quote>root</> authority that is trusted by the server.  The root
   certificate should be included in every case where
   <filename>postgresql.crt</> contains more than one certificate.
  </para>

  <para>
   Note that <filename>root.crt</filename> lists the top-level CAs that are
   considered trusted for signing server certificates.  In principle it need
   not list the CA that signed the client's certificate, though in most cases
   that CA would also be trusted for server certificates.
  </para>

6669
 </sect2>
6670 6671 6672 6673 6674 6675

 <sect2 id="libpq-ssl-protection">
  <title>Protection provided in different modes</title>

  <para>
   The different values for the <literal>sslmode</> parameter provide different
6676 6677
   levels of protection. SSL can provide
   protection against three types of attacks:
6678 6679 6680 6681 6682 6683 6684 6685 6686 6687 6688 6689 6690 6691
  </para>
  <table id="libpq-ssl-protect-attacks">
   <title>SSL attacks</title>
   <tgroup cols="2">
    <thead>
     <row>
      <entry>Type</entry>
      <entry>Description</entry>
     </row>
    </thead>

    <tbody>
     <row>
      <entry>Eavesdropping</entry>
6692
      <entry>If a third party can examine the network traffic between the
6693
       client and the server, it can read both connection information (including
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
6694
       the user name and password) and the data that is passed. <acronym>SSL</>
6695 6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704 6705 6706 6707 6708 6709 6710 6711 6712 6713 6714 6715 6716 6717 6718 6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725 6726
       uses encryption to prevent this.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry>Man in the middle (<acronym>MITM</>)</entry>
      <entry>If a third party can modify the data while passing between the
       client and server, it can pretend to be the server and therefore see and
       modify data <emphasis>even if it is encrypted</>. The third party can then
       forward the connection information and data to the original server,
       making it impossible to detect this attack. Common vectors to do this
       include DNS poisoning and address hijacking, whereby the client is directed
       to a different server than intended. There are also several other
       attack methods that can accomplish this. <acronym>SSL</> uses certificate
       verification to prevent this, by authenticating the server to the client.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry>Impersonation</entry>
      <entry>If a third party can pretend to be an authorized client, it can
       simply access data it should not have access to. Typically this can
       happen through insecure password management. <acronym>SSL</> uses
       client certificates to prevent this, by making sure that only holders
       of valid certificates can access the server.
      </entry>
     </row>
    </tbody>
   </tgroup>
  </table>

  <para>
6727 6728
   For a connection to be known secure, SSL usage must be configured
   on <emphasis>both the client and the server</> before the connection
6729 6730
   is made. If it is only configured on the server, the client may end up
   sending sensitive information (e.g. passwords) before
6731 6732
   it knows that the server requires high security. In libpq, secure
   connections can be ensured
6733 6734
   by setting the <literal>sslmode</> parameter to <literal>verify-full</> or
   <literal>verify-ca</>, and providing the system with a root certificate to
6735
   verify against. This is analogous to using an <literal>https</>
6736 6737 6738 6739 6740 6741
   <acronym>URL</> for encrypted web browsing.
  </para>

  <para>
   Once the server has been authenticated, the client can pass sensitive data.
   This means that up until this point, the client does not need to know if
6742
   certificates will be used for authentication, making it safe to specify that
6743 6744 6745 6746 6747
   only in the server configuration.
  </para>

  <para>
   All <acronym>SSL</> options carry overhead in the form of encryption and
6748
   key-exchange, so there is a tradeoff that has to be made between performance
6749 6750 6751 6752 6753 6754 6755 6756 6757 6758 6759 6760 6761 6762 6763 6764 6765 6766 6767 6768 6769 6770 6771 6772 6773 6774 6775 6776 6777 6778 6779 6780 6781 6782 6783 6784 6785 6786 6787 6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794 6795 6796 6797 6798 6799 6800 6801 6802 6803 6804 6805 6806 6807 6808 6809 6810 6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822 6823 6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829
   and security. The following table illustrates the risks the different
   <literal>sslmode</> values protect against, and what statement they make
   about security and overhead:
  </para>

  <table id="libpq-ssl-sslmode-statements">
   <title>SSL mode descriptions</title>
   <tgroup cols="4">
    <thead>
     <row>
      <entry><literal>sslmode</></entry>
      <entry>Eavesdropping protection</entry>
      <entry><acronym>MITM</> protection</entry>
      <entry>Statement</entry>
     </row>
    </thead>

    <tbody>
     <row>
      <entry><literal>disabled</></entry>
      <entry>No</entry>
      <entry>No</entry>
      <entry>I don't care about security, and I don't want to pay the overhead
       of encryption.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><literal>allow</></entry>
      <entry>Maybe</entry>
      <entry>No</entry>
      <entry>I don't care about security, but I will pay the overhead of
       encryption if the server insists on it.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><literal>prefer</></entry>
      <entry>Maybe</entry>
      <entry>No</entry>
      <entry>I don't care about encryption, but I wish to pay the overhead of
       encryption if the server supports it.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><literal>require</></entry>
      <entry>Yes</entry>
      <entry>No</entry>
      <entry>I want my data to be encrypted, and I accept the overhead. I trust
       that the network will make sure I always connect to the server I want.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><literal>verify-ca</></entry>
      <entry>Yes</entry>
      <entry><literal>Depends on CA</>-policy</entry>
      <entry>I want my data encrypted, and I accept the overhead. I want to be
       sure that I connect to a server that I trust.
      </entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><literal>verify-full</></entry>
       <entry>Yes</entry>
       <entry>Yes</entry>
       <entry>I want my data encrypted, and I accept the overhead. I want to be
        sure that I connect to a server I trust, and that it's the one I
        specify.
       </entry>
      </row>

    </tbody>
   </tgroup>
  </table>

  <para>
   The difference between <literal>verify-ca</> and <literal>verify-full</>
   depends on the policy of the root <acronym>CA</>. If a public
   <acronym>CA</> is used, <literal>verify-ca</> allows connections to a server
6830 6831
   that <emphasis>somebody else</> may have registered with the <acronym>CA</>.
   In this case, <literal>verify-full</> should always be used. If
6832 6833 6834 6835 6836 6837 6838 6839
   a local <acronym>CA</> is used, or even a self-signed certificate, using
   <literal>verify-ca</> often provides enough protection.
  </para>

  <para>
   The default value for <literal>sslmode</> is <literal>prefer</>. As is shown
   in the table, this makes no sense from a security point of view, and it only
   promises performance overhead if possible. It is only provided as the default
6840
   for backwards compatibility, and is not recommended in secure deployments.
6841 6842 6843 6844
  </para>

 </sect2>

6845 6846
 <sect2 id="libpq-ssl-fileusage">
  <title>SSL File Usage</title>
6847
  <table id="libpq-ssl-file-usage">
6848
   <title>Libpq/Client SSL File Usage</title>
6849 6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856 6857 6858 6859 6860 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6866 6867 6868
   <tgroup cols="3">
    <thead>
     <row>
      <entry>File</entry>
      <entry>Contents</entry>
      <entry>Effect</entry>
     </row>
    </thead>

    <tbody>

     <row>
      <entry><filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.crt</></entry>
      <entry>client certificate</entry>
      <entry>requested by server</entry>
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><filename>~/.postgresql/postgresql.key</></entry>
      <entry>client private key</entry>
6869 6870
      <entry>proves client certificate sent by owner; does not indicate
      certificate owner is trustworthy</entry>
6871 6872 6873 6874 6875
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><filename>~/.postgresql/root.crt</></entry>
      <entry>trusted certificate authorities</entry>
6876
      <entry>checks that server certificate is signed by a trusted certificate
6877
      authority</entry>
6878 6879 6880 6881 6882 6883 6884 6885 6886 6887 6888
     </row>

     <row>
      <entry><filename>~/.postgresql/root.crl</></entry>
      <entry>certificates revoked by certificate authorities</entry>
      <entry>server certificate must not be on this list</entry>
     </row>

    </tbody>
   </tgroup>
  </table>
6889 6890 6891 6892
 </sect2>

 <sect2 id="libpq-ssl-initialize">
  <title>SSL library initialization</title>
6893

6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906 6907 6908 6909
  <para>
   If your application initializes <literal>libssl</> and/or
   <literal>libcrypto</> libraries and <application>libpq</application>
   is built with <acronym>SSL</> support, you should call
   <function>PQinitOpenSSL</> to tell <application>libpq</application>
   that the <literal>libssl</> and/or <literal>libcrypto</> libraries
   have been initialized by your application, so that
   <application>libpq</application> will not also initialize those libraries.
   <!-- If this URL changes replace it with a URL to www.archive.org. -->
   See <ulink
   url="http://h71000.www7.hp.com/doc/83final/BA554_90007/ch04.html"></ulink>
   for details on the SSL API.
  </para>

  <para>
   <variablelist>
6910
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqinitopenssl">
6911 6912 6913 6914 6915 6916 6917 6918 6919 6920
     <term>
      <function>PQinitOpenSSL</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQinitOpenSSL</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Allows applications to select which security libraries to initialize.
6921 6922 6923
<synopsis>
void PQinitOpenSSL(int do_ssl, int do_crypto);
</synopsis>
6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938 6939 6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945
      </para>

      <para>
       When <parameter>do_ssl</> is non-zero, <application>libpq</application>
       will initialize the <application>OpenSSL</> library before first
       opening a database connection.  When <parameter>do_crypto</> is
       non-zero, the <literal>libcrypto</> library will be initialized.  By
       default (if <function>PQinitOpenSSL</> is not called), both libraries
       are initialized.  When SSL support is not compiled in, this function is
       present but does nothing.
      </para>

      <para>
       If your application uses and initializes either <application>OpenSSL</>
       or its underlying <literal>libcrypto</> library, you <emphasis>must</>
       call this function with zeroes for the appropriate parameter(s)
       before first opening a database connection.  Also be sure that you
       have done that initialization before opening a database connection.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>

6946
    <varlistentry id="libpq-pqinitssl">
6947 6948 6949 6950 6951 6952 6953 6954 6955 6956
     <term>
      <function>PQinitSSL</function>
      <indexterm>
       <primary>PQinitSSL</primary>
      </indexterm>
     </term>

     <listitem>
      <para>
       Allows applications to select which security libraries to initialize.
6957 6958 6959
<synopsis>
void PQinitSSL(int do_ssl);
</synopsis>
6960 6961 6962 6963 6964 6965 6966 6967 6968 6969 6970 6971 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6977 6978 6979
      </para>

      <para>
       This function is equivalent to
       <literal>PQinitOpenSSL(do_ssl, do_ssl)</>.
       It is sufficient for applications that initialize both or neither
       of <application>OpenSSL</> and <literal>libcrypto</>.
      </para>

      <para>
       <function>PQinitSSL</> has been present since
       <productname>PostgreSQL</> 8.0, while <function>PQinitOpenSSL</>
       was added in <productname>PostgreSQL</> 8.4, so <function>PQinitSSL</>
       might be preferable for applications that need to work with older
       versions of <application>libpq</application>.
      </para>
     </listitem>
    </varlistentry>
   </variablelist>
  </para>
6980
 </sect2>
6981

6982
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6983 6984


6985 6986
 <sect1 id="libpq-threading">
  <title>Behavior in Threaded Programs</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6987

6988 6989 6990 6991
  <indexterm zone="libpq-threading">
   <primary>threads</primary>
   <secondary>with libpq</secondary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6992

6993
  <para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6994 6995
   <application>libpq</application> is reentrant and thread-safe by default.
   You might need to use special compiler command-line
6996 6997
   options when you compile your application code.  Refer to your
   system's documentation for information about how to build
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
6998
   thread-enabled applications, or look in
6999 7000 7001 7002
   <filename>src/Makefile.global</filename> for <literal>PTHREAD_CFLAGS</>
   and <literal>PTHREAD_LIBS</>.  This function allows the querying of
   <application>libpq</application>'s thread-safe status:
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7003

7004
  <variablelist>
7005
   <varlistentry id="libpq-pqisthreadsafe">
7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011
    <term>
     <function>PQisthreadsafe</function>
     <indexterm>
      <primary>PQisthreadsafe</primary>
     </indexterm>
    </term>
7012

7013 7014 7015 7016
    <listitem>
     <para>
      Returns the thread safety status of the
      <application>libpq</application> library.
7017 7018 7019
<synopsis>
int PQisthreadsafe();
</synopsis>
7020
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7021

7022 7023 7024 7025 7026 7027 7028
     <para>
      Returns 1 if the <application>libpq</application> is thread-safe
      and 0 if it is not.
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </varlistentry>
  </variablelist>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7029

7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036
  <para>
   One thread restriction is that no two threads attempt to manipulate
   the same <structname>PGconn</> object at the same time. In particular,
   you cannot issue concurrent commands from different threads through
   the same connection object. (If you need to run concurrent commands,
   use multiple connections.)
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7037

7038 7039 7040 7041
  <para>
   <structname>PGresult</> objects are read-only after creation, and so
   can be passed around freely between threads.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7042

7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048 7049 7050
  <para>
   The deprecated functions <function>PQrequestCancel</function> and
   <function>PQoidStatus</function> are not thread-safe and should not be
   used in multithread programs.  <function>PQrequestCancel</function>
   can be replaced by <function>PQcancel</function>.
   <function>PQoidStatus</function> can be replaced by
   <function>PQoidValue</function>.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7051

7052 7053 7054 7055 7056 7057 7058 7059
  <para>
   If you are using Kerberos inside your application (in addition to inside
   <application>libpq</application>), you will need to do locking around
   Kerberos calls because Kerberos functions are not thread-safe.  See
   function <function>PQregisterThreadLock</> in the
   <application>libpq</application> source code for a way to do cooperative
   locking between <application>libpq</application> and your application.
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7060

7061 7062 7063 7064 7065 7066 7067 7068
  <para>
   If you experience problems with threaded applications, run the program
   in <filename>src/tools/thread</> to see if your platform has
   thread-unsafe functions.  This program is run by
   <filename>configure</filename>, but for binary distributions your
   library might not match the library used to build the binaries.
  </para>
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7069 7070


7071
 <sect1 id="libpq-build">
7072
  <title>Building <application>libpq</application> Programs</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7073

P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7074 7075 7076 7077
  <indexterm zone="libpq-build">
   <primary>compiling</primary>
   <secondary>libpq applications</secondary>
  </indexterm>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7078

7079
  <para>
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7080
   To build (i.e., compile and link) a program using
7081 7082
   <application>libpq</application> you need to do all of the following
   things:
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7083

7084 7085 7086 7087 7088
   <itemizedlist>
    <listitem>
     <para>
      Include the <filename>libpq-fe.h</filename> header file:
<programlisting>
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7089
#include &lt;libpq-fe.h&gt;
7090
</programlisting>
7091
      If you failed to do that then you will normally get error messages
7092
      from your compiler similar to:
7093 7094 7095 7096 7097 7098 7099 7100 7101 7102
<screen>
foo.c: In function `main':
foo.c:34: `PGconn' undeclared (first use in this function)
foo.c:35: `PGresult' undeclared (first use in this function)
foo.c:54: `CONNECTION_BAD' undeclared (first use in this function)
foo.c:68: `PGRES_COMMAND_OK' undeclared (first use in this function)
foo.c:95: `PGRES_TUPLES_OK' undeclared (first use in this function)
</screen>
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7103

7104 7105
    <listitem>
     <para>
7106
      Point your compiler to the directory where the <productname>PostgreSQL</> header
7107 7108 7109 7110 7111 7112 7113 7114 7115 7116 7117 7118 7119 7120 7121
      files were installed, by supplying the
      <literal>-I<replaceable>directory</replaceable></literal> option
      to your compiler.  (In some cases the compiler will look into
      the directory in question by default, so you can omit this
      option.)  For instance, your compile command line could look
      like:
<programlisting>
cc -c -I/usr/local/pgsql/include testprog.c
</programlisting>
      If you are using makefiles then add the option to the
      <varname>CPPFLAGS</varname> variable:
<programlisting>
CPPFLAGS += -I/usr/local/pgsql/include
</programlisting>
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7122

7123 7124 7125 7126
     <para>
      If there is any chance that your program might be compiled by
      other users then you should not hardcode the directory location
      like that.  Instead, you can run the utility
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7127 7128 7129
      <command>pg_config</command><indexterm><primary>pg_config</><secondary
      sortas="libpq">with libpq</></> to find out where the header
      files are on the local system:
7130 7131 7132 7133 7134
<screen>
<prompt>$</prompt> pg_config --includedir
<computeroutput>/usr/local/include</computeroutput>
</screen>
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7135

7136 7137
     <para>
      Failure to specify the correct option to the compiler will
7138
      result in an error message such as:
7139 7140 7141 7142 7143
<screen>
testlibpq.c:8:22: libpq-fe.h: No such file or directory
</screen>
     </para>
    </listitem>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7144

7145 7146 7147
    <listitem>
     <para>
      When linking the final program, specify the option
7148 7149 7150 7151 7152
      <literal>-lpq</literal> so that the <application>libpq</application>
      library gets pulled in, as well as the option
      <literal>-L<replaceable>directory</replaceable></literal> to point
      the compiler to the directory where the
      <application>libpq</application> library resides.  (Again, the
7153 7154 7155 7156 7157 7158 7159
      compiler will search some directories by default.)  For maximum
      portability, put the <option>-L</option> option before the
      <option>-lpq</option> option.  For example:
<programlisting>
cc -o testprog testprog1.o testprog2.o -L/usr/local/pgsql/lib -lpq
</programlisting>
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7160

7161 7162 7163 7164 7165 7166 7167 7168
     <para>
      You can find out the library directory using
      <command>pg_config</command> as well:
<screen>
<prompt>$</prompt> pg_config --libdir
<computeroutput>/usr/local/pgsql/lib</computeroutput>
</screen>
     </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7169

7170
     <para>
7171
      Error messages that point to problems in this area could look like
7172
      the following:
7173 7174 7175 7176 7177 7178 7179 7180 7181 7182
<screen>
testlibpq.o: In function `main':
testlibpq.o(.text+0x60): undefined reference to `PQsetdbLogin'
testlibpq.o(.text+0x71): undefined reference to `PQstatus'
testlibpq.o(.text+0xa4): undefined reference to `PQerrorMessage'
</screen>
      This means you forgot <option>-lpq</option>.
<screen>
/usr/bin/ld: cannot find -lpq
</screen>
7183 7184
      This means you forgot the <option>-L</option> option or did not
      specify the right directory.
7185 7186 7187 7188
     </para>
    </listitem>
   </itemizedlist>
  </para>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7189

7190
 </sect1>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7191 7192


7193 7194
 <sect1 id="libpq-example">
  <title>Example Programs</title>
B
Bruce Momjian 已提交
7195

7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201
  <para>
   These examples and others can be found in the
   directory <filename>src/test/examples</filename> in the source code
   distribution.
  </para>

7202
  <example id="libpq-example-1">
7203
   <title><application>libpq</application> Example Program 1</title>
7204

7205
<programlisting>
7206
<![CDATA[
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7207
/*
7208
 * testlibpq.c
7209
 *
7210
 *      Test the C version of libpq, the PostgreSQL frontend library.
7211
 */
7212 7213
#include <stdio.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
7214
#include <libpq-fe.h>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7215

7216
static void
7217
exit_nicely(PGconn *conn)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7218
{
7219 7220
    PQfinish(conn);
    exit(1);
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7221 7222
}

7223 7224
int
main(int argc, char **argv)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7225
{
7226 7227 7228 7229 7230 7231 7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237
    const char *conninfo;
    PGconn     *conn;
    PGresult   *res;
    int         nFields;
    int         i,
                j;

    /*
     * If the user supplies a parameter on the command line, use it as the
     * conninfo string; otherwise default to setting dbname=postgres and using
     * environment variables or defaults for all other connection parameters.
     */
7238
    if (argc > 1)
7239 7240 7241 7242 7243 7244 7245 7246 7247 7248 7249 7250 7251 7252 7253 7254 7255 7256 7257 7258 7259 7260 7261 7262 7263 7264 7265
        conninfo = argv[1];
    else
        conninfo = "dbname = postgres";

    /* Make a connection to the database */
    conn = PQconnectdb(conninfo);

    /* Check to see that the backend connection was successfully made */
    if (PQstatus(conn) != CONNECTION_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "Connection to database failed: %s",
                PQerrorMessage(conn));
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    /*
     * Our test case here involves using a cursor, for which we must be inside
     * a transaction block.  We could do the whole thing with a single
     * PQexec() of "select * from pg_database", but that's too trivial to make
     * a good example.
     */

    /* Start a transaction block */
    res = PQexec(conn, "BEGIN");
    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "BEGIN command failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7266
        PQclear(res);
7267 7268 7269 7270 7271 7272 7273 7274 7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281 7282
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    /*
     * Should PQclear PGresult whenever it is no longer needed to avoid memory
     * leaks
     */
    PQclear(res);

    /*
     * Fetch rows from pg_database, the system catalog of databases
     */
    res = PQexec(conn, "DECLARE myportal CURSOR FOR select * from pg_database");
    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "DECLARE CURSOR failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7283
        PQclear(res);
7284 7285 7286 7287 7288 7289 7290 7291 7292 7293 7294
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }
    PQclear(res);

    res = PQexec(conn, "FETCH ALL in myportal");
    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "FETCH ALL failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
        PQclear(res);
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7295

7296 7297
    /* first, print out the attribute names */
    nFields = PQnfields(res);
7298
    for (i = 0; i < nFields; i++)
7299 7300
        printf("%-15s", PQfname(res, i));
    printf("\n\n");
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7301

7302
    /* next, print out the rows */
7303
    for (i = 0; i < PQntuples(res); i++)
7304
    {
7305
        for (j = 0; j < nFields; j++)
7306 7307 7308
            printf("%-15s", PQgetvalue(res, i, j));
        printf("\n");
    }
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7309

7310
    PQclear(res);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7311

7312 7313 7314
    /* close the portal ... we don't bother to check for errors ... */
    res = PQexec(conn, "CLOSE myportal");
    PQclear(res);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7315

7316 7317 7318
    /* end the transaction */
    res = PQexec(conn, "END");
    PQclear(res);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7319

7320 7321
    /* close the connection to the database and cleanup */
    PQfinish(conn);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7322

7323
    return 0;
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7324
}
7325
]]>
7326
</programlisting>
7327
  </example>
7328

7329
  <example id="libpq-example-2">
7330
   <title><application>libpq</application> Example Program 2</title>
7331

7332
<programlisting>
7333
<![CDATA[
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7334
/*
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7335
 * testlibpq2.c
7336
 *      Test of the asynchronous notification interface
7337
 *
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7338 7339
 * Start this program, then from psql in another window do
 *   NOTIFY TBL2;
7340
 * Repeat four times to get this program to exit.
7341
 *
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7342
 * Or, if you want to get fancy, try this:
7343 7344
 * populate a database with the following commands
 * (provided in src/test/examples/testlibpq2.sql):
7345
 *
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7346
 *   CREATE TABLE TBL1 (i int4);
7347
 *
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7348
 *   CREATE TABLE TBL2 (i int4);
7349
 *
T
Tom Lane 已提交
7350
 *   CREATE RULE r1 AS ON INSERT TO TBL1 DO
7351
 *     (INSERT INTO TBL2 VALUES (new.i); NOTIFY TBL2);
7352
 *
7353
 * and do this four times:
7354
 *
7355
 *   INSERT INTO TBL1 VALUES (10);
7356
 */
7357 7358 7359 7360 7361
#include <stdio.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <string.h>
#include <errno.h>
#include <sys/time.h>
7362
#include <libpq-fe.h>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7363

7364
static void
7365
exit_nicely(PGconn *conn)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7366
{
7367 7368
    PQfinish(conn);
    exit(1);
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7369 7370
}

7371 7372
int
main(int argc, char **argv)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7373
{
7374 7375 7376 7377 7378 7379 7380 7381 7382 7383 7384
    const char *conninfo;
    PGconn     *conn;
    PGresult   *res;
    PGnotify   *notify;
    int         nnotifies;

    /*
     * If the user supplies a parameter on the command line, use it as the
     * conninfo string; otherwise default to setting dbname=postgres and using
     * environment variables or defaults for all other connection parameters.
     */
7385
    if (argc > 1)
7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415 7416 7417 7418 7419
        conninfo = argv[1];
    else
        conninfo = "dbname = postgres";

    /* Make a connection to the database */
    conn = PQconnectdb(conninfo);

    /* Check to see that the backend connection was successfully made */
    if (PQstatus(conn) != CONNECTION_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "Connection to database failed: %s",
                PQerrorMessage(conn));
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    /*
     * Issue LISTEN command to enable notifications from the rule's NOTIFY.
     */
    res = PQexec(conn, "LISTEN TBL2");
    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_COMMAND_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "LISTEN command failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
        PQclear(res);
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    /*
     * should PQclear PGresult whenever it is no longer needed to avoid memory
     * leaks
     */
    PQclear(res);

    /* Quit after four notifies are received. */
    nnotifies = 0;
7420
    while (nnotifies < 4)
7421
    {
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7422
        /*
7423 7424 7425
         * Sleep until something happens on the connection.  We use select(2)
         * to wait for input, but you could also use poll() or similar
         * facilities.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7426
         */
7427 7428
        int         sock;
        fd_set      input_mask;
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7429

7430
        sock = PQsocket(conn);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7431

7432
        if (sock < 0)
7433
            break;              /* shouldn't happen */
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7434

7435 7436
        FD_ZERO(&input_mask);
        FD_SET(sock, &input_mask);
7437

7438
        if (select(sock + 1, &input_mask, NULL, NULL, NULL) < 0)
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7439
        {
7440 7441
            fprintf(stderr, "select() failed: %s\n", strerror(errno));
            exit_nicely(conn);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7442 7443
        }

7444 7445 7446
        /* Now check for input */
        PQconsumeInput(conn);
        while ((notify = PQnotifies(conn)) != NULL)
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7447
        {
7448 7449
            fprintf(stderr,
                    "ASYNC NOTIFY of '%s' received from backend pid %d\n",
7450
                    notify->relname, notify->be_pid);
7451 7452
            PQfreemem(notify);
            nnotifies++;
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7453
        }
7454
    }
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7455

7456
    fprintf(stderr, "Done.\n");
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7457

7458 7459
    /* close the connection to the database and cleanup */
    PQfinish(conn);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7460

7461
    return 0;
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7462
}
7463
]]>
7464
</programlisting>
7465
  </example>
7466

7467
  <example id="libpq-example-3">
7468
   <title><application>libpq</application> Example Program 3</>
7469

7470
<programlisting>
7471
<![CDATA[
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7472
/*
7473
 * testlibpq3.c
7474
 *      Test out-of-line parameters and binary I/O.
7475
 *
7476 7477
 * Before running this, populate a database with the following commands
 * (provided in src/test/examples/testlibpq3.sql):
7478
 *
7479
 * CREATE TABLE test1 (i int4, t text, b bytea);
7480
 *
7481 7482
 * INSERT INTO test1 values (1, 'joe''s place', '\\000\\001\\002\\003\\004');
 * INSERT INTO test1 values (2, 'ho there', '\\004\\003\\002\\001\\000');
7483
 *
7484
 * The expected output is:
7485
 *
7486 7487 7488 7489
 * tuple 0: got
 *  i = (4 bytes) 1
 *  t = (11 bytes) 'joe's place'
 *  b = (5 bytes) \000\001\002\003\004
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7490
 *
7491 7492 7493 7494
 * tuple 0: got
 *  i = (4 bytes) 2
 *  t = (8 bytes) 'ho there'
 *  b = (5 bytes) \004\003\002\001\000
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7495
 */
7496 7497 7498 7499
#include <stdio.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <string.h>
#include <sys/types.h>
7500
#include <libpq-fe.h>
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7501

7502
/* for ntohl/htonl */
7503 7504
#include <netinet/in.h>
#include <arpa/inet.h>
7505 7506 7507


static void
7508
exit_nicely(PGconn *conn)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7509
{
7510 7511
    PQfinish(conn);
    exit(1);
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7512 7513
}

7514 7515 7516 7517 7518 7519 7520
/*
 * This function prints a query result that is a binary-format fetch from
 * a table defined as in the comment above.  We split it out because the
 * main() function uses it twice.
 */
static void
show_binary_results(PGresult *res)
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7521
{
7522 7523 7524 7525 7526 7527 7528 7529 7530 7531 7532
    int         i,
                j;
    int         i_fnum,
                t_fnum,
                b_fnum;

    /* Use PQfnumber to avoid assumptions about field order in result */
    i_fnum = PQfnumber(res, "i");
    t_fnum = PQfnumber(res, "t");
    b_fnum = PQfnumber(res, "b");

7533
    for (i = 0; i < PQntuples(res); i++)
7534 7535 7536 7537 7538 7539 7540 7541 7542 7543 7544
    {
        char       *iptr;
        char       *tptr;
        char       *bptr;
        int         blen;
        int         ival;

        /* Get the field values (we ignore possibility they are null!) */
        iptr = PQgetvalue(res, i, i_fnum);
        tptr = PQgetvalue(res, i, t_fnum);
        bptr = PQgetvalue(res, i, b_fnum);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7545 7546

        /*
7547 7548
         * The binary representation of INT4 is in network byte order, which
         * we'd better coerce to the local byte order.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7549
         */
7550
        ival = ntohl(*((uint32_t *) iptr));
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7551 7552

        /*
7553 7554 7555 7556 7557 7558
         * The binary representation of TEXT is, well, text, and since libpq
         * was nice enough to append a zero byte to it, it'll work just fine
         * as a C string.
         *
         * The binary representation of BYTEA is a bunch of bytes, which could
         * include embedded nulls so we have to pay attention to field length.
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7559
         */
7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567
        blen = PQgetlength(res, i, b_fnum);

        printf("tuple %d: got\n", i);
        printf(" i = (%d bytes) %d\n",
               PQgetlength(res, i, i_fnum), ival);
        printf(" t = (%d bytes) '%s'\n",
               PQgetlength(res, i, t_fnum), tptr);
        printf(" b = (%d bytes) ", blen);
7568
        for (j = 0; j < blen; j++)
7569 7570 7571 7572
            printf("\\%03o", bptr[j]);
        printf("\n\n");
    }
}
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7573

7574 7575 7576 7577 7578 7579 7580 7581 7582 7583 7584 7585 7586 7587 7588 7589
int
main(int argc, char **argv)
{
    const char *conninfo;
    PGconn     *conn;
    PGresult   *res;
    const char *paramValues[1];
    int         paramLengths[1];
    int         paramFormats[1];
    uint32_t    binaryIntVal;

    /*
     * If the user supplies a parameter on the command line, use it as the
     * conninfo string; otherwise default to setting dbname=postgres and using
     * environment variables or defaults for all other connection parameters.
     */
7590
    if (argc > 1)
7591 7592 7593 7594 7595 7596 7597 7598 7599 7600 7601 7602 7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608 7609 7610 7611 7612 7613 7614 7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622 7623 7624 7625 7626 7627 7628 7629 7630 7631 7632 7633 7634 7635 7636 7637 7638 7639 7640 7641 7642 7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652 7653
        conninfo = argv[1];
    else
        conninfo = "dbname = postgres";

    /* Make a connection to the database */
    conn = PQconnectdb(conninfo);

    /* Check to see that the backend connection was successfully made */
    if (PQstatus(conn) != CONNECTION_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "Connection to database failed: %s",
                PQerrorMessage(conn));
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    /*
     * The point of this program is to illustrate use of PQexecParams() with
     * out-of-line parameters, as well as binary transmission of data.
     *
     * This first example transmits the parameters as text, but receives the
     * results in binary format.  By using out-of-line parameters we can
     * avoid a lot of tedious mucking about with quoting and escaping, even
     * though the data is text.  Notice how we don't have to do anything
     * special with the quote mark in the parameter value.
     */

    /* Here is our out-of-line parameter value */
    paramValues[0] = "joe's place";

    res = PQexecParams(conn,
                       "SELECT * FROM test1 WHERE t = $1",
                       1,       /* one param */
                       NULL,    /* let the backend deduce param type */
                       paramValues,
                       NULL,    /* don't need param lengths since text */
                       NULL,    /* default to all text params */
                       1);      /* ask for binary results */

    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "SELECT failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
        PQclear(res);
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }

    show_binary_results(res);

    PQclear(res);

    /*
     * In this second example we transmit an integer parameter in binary
     * form, and again retrieve the results in binary form.
     *
     * Although we tell PQexecParams we are letting the backend deduce
     * parameter type, we really force the decision by casting the parameter
     * symbol in the query text.  This is a good safety measure when sending
     * binary parameters.
     */

    /* Convert integer value "2" to network byte order */
    binaryIntVal = htonl((uint32_t) 2);

    /* Set up parameter arrays for PQexecParams */
7654
    paramValues[0] = (char *) &binaryIntVal;
7655 7656 7657 7658 7659 7660 7661 7662 7663 7664 7665 7666 7667 7668 7669 7670 7671 7672
    paramLengths[0] = sizeof(binaryIntVal);
    paramFormats[0] = 1;        /* binary */

    res = PQexecParams(conn,
                       "SELECT * FROM test1 WHERE i = $1::int4",
                       1,       /* one param */
                       NULL,    /* let the backend deduce param type */
                       paramValues,
                       paramLengths,
                       paramFormats,
                       1);      /* ask for binary results */

    if (PQresultStatus(res) != PGRES_TUPLES_OK)
    {
        fprintf(stderr, "SELECT failed: %s", PQerrorMessage(conn));
        PQclear(res);
        exit_nicely(conn);
    }
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7673

7674
    show_binary_results(res);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7675

7676
    PQclear(res);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7677

7678 7679
    /* close the connection to the database and cleanup */
    PQfinish(conn);
P
Peter Eisentraut 已提交
7680

7681
    return 0;
T
Thomas G. Lockhart 已提交
7682
}
7683
]]>
7684
</programlisting>
7685
  </example>
7686

7687
 </sect1>
7688
</chapter>